/* ** 2004 April 6 ** ** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of ** a legal notice, here is a blessing: ** ** May you do good and not evil. ** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. ** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. ** ************************************************************************* ** This file implements an external (disk-based) database using BTrees. ** See the header comment on "btreeInt.h" for additional information. ** Including a description of file format and an overview of operation. */ #include "btreeInt.h" /* ** The header string that appears at the beginning of every ** SQLite database. */ static const char zMagicHeader[] = SQLITE_FILE_HEADER; /* ** Set this global variable to 1 to enable tracing using the TRACE ** macro. */ #if 0 int sqlite3BtreeTrace=1; /* True to enable tracing */ # define TRACE(X) if(sqlite3BtreeTrace){printf X;fflush(stdout);} #else # define TRACE(X) #endif /* ** Extract a 2-byte big-endian integer from an array of unsigned bytes. ** But if the value is zero, make it 65536. ** ** This routine is used to extract the "offset to cell content area" value ** from the header of a btree page. If the page size is 65536 and the page ** is empty, the offset should be 65536, but the 2-byte value stores zero. ** This routine makes the necessary adjustment to 65536. */ #define get2byteNotZero(X) (((((int)get2byte(X))-1)&0xffff)+1) /* ** Values passed as the 5th argument to allocateBtreePage() */ #define BTALLOC_ANY 0 /* Allocate any page */ #define BTALLOC_EXACT 1 /* Allocate exact page if possible */ #define BTALLOC_LE 2 /* Allocate any page <= the parameter */ /* ** Macro IfNotOmitAV(x) returns (x) if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM is not ** defined, or 0 if it is. For example: ** ** bIncrVacuum = IfNotOmitAV(pBtShared->incrVacuum); */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM #define IfNotOmitAV(expr) (expr) #else #define IfNotOmitAV(expr) 0 #endif #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** A list of BtShared objects that are eligible for participation ** in shared cache. This variable has file scope during normal builds, ** but the test harness needs to access it so we make it global for ** test builds. ** ** Access to this variable is protected by SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER. */ #ifdef SQLITE_TEST BtShared *SQLITE_WSD sqlite3SharedCacheList = 0; #else static BtShared *SQLITE_WSD sqlite3SharedCacheList = 0; #endif #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** Enable or disable the shared pager and schema features. ** ** This routine has no effect on existing database connections. ** The shared cache setting effects only future calls to ** sqlite3_open(), sqlite3_open16(), or sqlite3_open_v2(). */ int sqlite3_enable_shared_cache(int enable){ sqlite3GlobalConfig.sharedCacheEnabled = enable; return SQLITE_OK; } #endif #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** The functions querySharedCacheTableLock(), setSharedCacheTableLock(), ** and clearAllSharedCacheTableLocks() ** manipulate entries in the BtShared.pLock linked list used to store ** shared-cache table level locks. If the library is compiled with the ** shared-cache feature disabled, then there is only ever one user ** of each BtShared structure and so this locking is not necessary. ** So define the lock related functions as no-ops. */ #define querySharedCacheTableLock(a,b,c) SQLITE_OK #define setSharedCacheTableLock(a,b,c) SQLITE_OK #define clearAllSharedCacheTableLocks(a) #define downgradeAllSharedCacheTableLocks(a) #define hasSharedCacheTableLock(a,b,c,d) 1 #define hasReadConflicts(a, b) 0 #endif /* ** Implementation of the SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE() macro. Takes a single ** (MemPage*) as an argument. The (MemPage*) must not be NULL. ** ** If SQLITE_DEBUG is not defined, then this macro is equivalent to ** SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT. Or, if SQLITE_DEBUG is set, then the log message ** normally produced as a side-effect of SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT is augmented ** with the page number and filename associated with the (MemPage*). */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG int corruptPageError(int lineno, MemPage *p){ char *zMsg; sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc(); zMsg = sqlite3_mprintf("database corruption page %d of %s", (int)p->pgno, sqlite3PagerFilename(p->pBt->pPager, 0) ); sqlite3EndBenignMalloc(); if( zMsg ){ sqlite3ReportError(SQLITE_CORRUPT, lineno, zMsg); } sqlite3_free(zMsg); return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } # define SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pMemPage) corruptPageError(__LINE__, pMemPage) #else # define SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pMemPage) SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(pMemPage->pgno) #endif #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* **** This function is only used as part of an assert() statement. *** ** ** Check to see if pBtree holds the required locks to read or write to the ** table with root page iRoot. Return 1 if it does and 0 if not. ** ** For example, when writing to a table with root-page iRoot via ** Btree connection pBtree: ** ** assert( hasSharedCacheTableLock(pBtree, iRoot, 0, WRITE_LOCK) ); ** ** When writing to an index that resides in a sharable database, the ** caller should have first obtained a lock specifying the root page of ** the corresponding table. This makes things a bit more complicated, ** as this module treats each table as a separate structure. To determine ** the table corresponding to the index being written, this ** function has to search through the database schema. ** ** Instead of a lock on the table/index rooted at page iRoot, the caller may ** hold a write-lock on the schema table (root page 1). This is also ** acceptable. */ static int hasSharedCacheTableLock( Btree *pBtree, /* Handle that must hold lock */ Pgno iRoot, /* Root page of b-tree */ int isIndex, /* True if iRoot is the root of an index b-tree */ int eLockType /* Required lock type (READ_LOCK or WRITE_LOCK) */ ){ Schema *pSchema = (Schema *)pBtree->pBt->pSchema; Pgno iTab = 0; BtLock *pLock; /* If this database is not shareable, or if the client is reading ** and has the read-uncommitted flag set, then no lock is required. ** Return true immediately. */ if( (pBtree->sharable==0) || (eLockType==READ_LOCK && (pBtree->db->flags & SQLITE_ReadUncommit)) ){ return 1; } /* If the client is reading or writing an index and the schema is ** not loaded, then it is too difficult to actually check to see if ** the correct locks are held. So do not bother - just return true. ** This case does not come up very often anyhow. */ if( isIndex && (!pSchema || (pSchema->schemaFlags&DB_SchemaLoaded)==0) ){ return 1; } /* Figure out the root-page that the lock should be held on. For table ** b-trees, this is just the root page of the b-tree being read or ** written. For index b-trees, it is the root page of the associated ** table. */ if( isIndex ){ HashElem *p; for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&pSchema->idxHash); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){ Index *pIdx = (Index *)sqliteHashData(p); if( pIdx->tnum==(int)iRoot ){ if( iTab ){ /* Two or more indexes share the same root page. There must ** be imposter tables. So just return true. The assert is not ** useful in that case. */ return 1; } iTab = pIdx->pTable->tnum; } } }else{ iTab = iRoot; } /* Search for the required lock. Either a write-lock on root-page iTab, a ** write-lock on the schema table, or (if the client is reading) a ** read-lock on iTab will suffice. Return 1 if any of these are found. */ for(pLock=pBtree->pBt->pLock; pLock; pLock=pLock->pNext){ if( pLock->pBtree==pBtree && (pLock->iTable==iTab || (pLock->eLock==WRITE_LOCK && pLock->iTable==1)) && pLock->eLock>=eLockType ){ return 1; } } /* Failed to find the required lock. */ return 0; } #endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* **** This function may be used as part of assert() statements only. **** ** ** Return true if it would be illegal for pBtree to write into the ** table or index rooted at iRoot because other shared connections are ** simultaneously reading that same table or index. ** ** It is illegal for pBtree to write if some other Btree object that ** shares the same BtShared object is currently reading or writing ** the iRoot table. Except, if the other Btree object has the ** read-uncommitted flag set, then it is OK for the other object to ** have a read cursor. ** ** For example, before writing to any part of the table or index ** rooted at page iRoot, one should call: ** ** assert( !hasReadConflicts(pBtree, iRoot) ); */ static int hasReadConflicts(Btree *pBtree, Pgno iRoot){ BtCursor *p; for(p=pBtree->pBt->pCursor; p; p=p->pNext){ if( p->pgnoRoot==iRoot && p->pBtree!=pBtree && 0==(p->pBtree->db->flags & SQLITE_ReadUncommit) ){ return 1; } } return 0; } #endif /* #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG */ /* ** Query to see if Btree handle p may obtain a lock of type eLock ** (READ_LOCK or WRITE_LOCK) on the table with root-page iTab. Return ** SQLITE_OK if the lock may be obtained (by calling ** setSharedCacheTableLock()), or SQLITE_LOCKED if not. */ static int querySharedCacheTableLock(Btree *p, Pgno iTab, u8 eLock){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; BtLock *pIter; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( eLock==READ_LOCK || eLock==WRITE_LOCK ); assert( p->db!=0 ); assert( !(p->db->flags&SQLITE_ReadUncommit)||eLock==WRITE_LOCK||iTab==1 ); /* If requesting a write-lock, then the Btree must have an open write ** transaction on this file. And, obviously, for this to be so there ** must be an open write transaction on the file itself. */ assert( eLock==READ_LOCK || (p==pBt->pWriter && p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE) ); assert( eLock==READ_LOCK || pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); /* This routine is a no-op if the shared-cache is not enabled */ if( !p->sharable ){ return SQLITE_OK; } /* If some other connection is holding an exclusive lock, the ** requested lock may not be obtained. */ if( pBt->pWriter!=p && (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_EXCLUSIVE)!=0 ){ sqlite3ConnectionBlocked(p->db, pBt->pWriter->db); return SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE; } for(pIter=pBt->pLock; pIter; pIter=pIter->pNext){ /* The condition (pIter->eLock!=eLock) in the following if(...) ** statement is a simplification of: ** ** (eLock==WRITE_LOCK || pIter->eLock==WRITE_LOCK) ** ** since we know that if eLock==WRITE_LOCK, then no other connection ** may hold a WRITE_LOCK on any table in this file (since there can ** only be a single writer). */ assert( pIter->eLock==READ_LOCK || pIter->eLock==WRITE_LOCK ); assert( eLock==READ_LOCK || pIter->pBtree==p || pIter->eLock==READ_LOCK); if( pIter->pBtree!=p && pIter->iTable==iTab && pIter->eLock!=eLock ){ sqlite3ConnectionBlocked(p->db, pIter->pBtree->db); if( eLock==WRITE_LOCK ){ assert( p==pBt->pWriter ); pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_PENDING; } return SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE; } } return SQLITE_OK; } #endif /* !SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** Add a lock on the table with root-page iTable to the shared-btree used ** by Btree handle p. Parameter eLock must be either READ_LOCK or ** WRITE_LOCK. ** ** This function assumes the following: ** ** (a) The specified Btree object p is connected to a sharable ** database (one with the BtShared.sharable flag set), and ** ** (b) No other Btree objects hold a lock that conflicts ** with the requested lock (i.e. querySharedCacheTableLock() has ** already been called and returned SQLITE_OK). ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned if the lock is added successfully. SQLITE_NOMEM ** is returned if a malloc attempt fails. */ static int setSharedCacheTableLock(Btree *p, Pgno iTable, u8 eLock){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; BtLock *pLock = 0; BtLock *pIter; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( eLock==READ_LOCK || eLock==WRITE_LOCK ); assert( p->db!=0 ); /* A connection with the read-uncommitted flag set will never try to ** obtain a read-lock using this function. The only read-lock obtained ** by a connection in read-uncommitted mode is on the sqlite_master ** table, and that lock is obtained in BtreeBeginTrans(). */ assert( 0==(p->db->flags&SQLITE_ReadUncommit) || eLock==WRITE_LOCK ); /* This function should only be called on a sharable b-tree after it ** has been determined that no other b-tree holds a conflicting lock. */ assert( p->sharable ); assert( SQLITE_OK==querySharedCacheTableLock(p, iTable, eLock) ); /* First search the list for an existing lock on this table. */ for(pIter=pBt->pLock; pIter; pIter=pIter->pNext){ if( pIter->iTable==iTable && pIter->pBtree==p ){ pLock = pIter; break; } } /* If the above search did not find a BtLock struct associating Btree p ** with table iTable, allocate one and link it into the list. */ if( !pLock ){ pLock = (BtLock *)sqlite3MallocZero(sizeof(BtLock)); if( !pLock ){ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } pLock->iTable = iTable; pLock->pBtree = p; pLock->pNext = pBt->pLock; pBt->pLock = pLock; } /* Set the BtLock.eLock variable to the maximum of the current lock ** and the requested lock. This means if a write-lock was already held ** and a read-lock requested, we don't incorrectly downgrade the lock. */ assert( WRITE_LOCK>READ_LOCK ); if( eLock>pLock->eLock ){ pLock->eLock = eLock; } return SQLITE_OK; } #endif /* !SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** Release all the table locks (locks obtained via calls to ** the setSharedCacheTableLock() procedure) held by Btree object p. ** ** This function assumes that Btree p has an open read or write ** transaction. If it does not, then the BTS_PENDING flag ** may be incorrectly cleared. */ static void clearAllSharedCacheTableLocks(Btree *p){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; BtLock **ppIter = &pBt->pLock; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( p->sharable || 0==*ppIter ); assert( p->inTrans>0 ); while( *ppIter ){ BtLock *pLock = *ppIter; assert( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_EXCLUSIVE)==0 || pBt->pWriter==pLock->pBtree ); assert( pLock->pBtree->inTrans>=pLock->eLock ); if( pLock->pBtree==p ){ *ppIter = pLock->pNext; assert( pLock->iTable!=1 || pLock==&p->lock ); if( pLock->iTable!=1 ){ sqlite3_free(pLock); } }else{ ppIter = &pLock->pNext; } } assert( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_PENDING)==0 || pBt->pWriter ); if( pBt->pWriter==p ){ pBt->pWriter = 0; pBt->btsFlags &= ~(BTS_EXCLUSIVE|BTS_PENDING); }else if( pBt->nTransaction==2 ){ /* This function is called when Btree p is concluding its ** transaction. If there currently exists a writer, and p is not ** that writer, then the number of locks held by connections other ** than the writer must be about to drop to zero. In this case ** set the BTS_PENDING flag to 0. ** ** If there is not currently a writer, then BTS_PENDING must ** be zero already. So this next line is harmless in that case. */ pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_PENDING; } } /* ** This function changes all write-locks held by Btree p into read-locks. */ static void downgradeAllSharedCacheTableLocks(Btree *p){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; if( pBt->pWriter==p ){ BtLock *pLock; pBt->pWriter = 0; pBt->btsFlags &= ~(BTS_EXCLUSIVE|BTS_PENDING); for(pLock=pBt->pLock; pLock; pLock=pLock->pNext){ assert( pLock->eLock==READ_LOCK || pLock->pBtree==p ); pLock->eLock = READ_LOCK; } } } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE */ static void releasePage(MemPage *pPage); /* Forward reference */ static void releasePageOne(MemPage *pPage); /* Forward reference */ static void releasePageNotNull(MemPage *pPage); /* Forward reference */ /* ***** This routine is used inside of assert() only **** ** ** Verify that the cursor holds the mutex on its BtShared */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG static int cursorHoldsMutex(BtCursor *p){ return sqlite3_mutex_held(p->pBt->mutex); } /* Verify that the cursor and the BtShared agree about what is the current ** database connetion. This is important in shared-cache mode. If the database ** connection pointers get out-of-sync, it is possible for routines like ** btreeInitPage() to reference an stale connection pointer that references a ** a connection that has already closed. This routine is used inside assert() ** statements only and for the purpose of double-checking that the btree code ** does keep the database connection pointers up-to-date. */ static int cursorOwnsBtShared(BtCursor *p){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(p) ); return (p->pBtree->db==p->pBt->db); } #endif /* ** Invalidate the overflow cache of the cursor passed as the first argument. ** on the shared btree structure pBt. */ #define invalidateOverflowCache(pCur) (pCur->curFlags &= ~BTCF_ValidOvfl) /* ** Invalidate the overflow page-list cache for all cursors opened ** on the shared btree structure pBt. */ static void invalidateAllOverflowCache(BtShared *pBt){ BtCursor *p; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); for(p=pBt->pCursor; p; p=p->pNext){ invalidateOverflowCache(p); } } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB /* ** This function is called before modifying the contents of a table ** to invalidate any incrblob cursors that are open on the ** row or one of the rows being modified. ** ** If argument isClearTable is true, then the entire contents of the ** table is about to be deleted. In this case invalidate all incrblob ** cursors open on any row within the table with root-page pgnoRoot. ** ** Otherwise, if argument isClearTable is false, then the row with ** rowid iRow is being replaced or deleted. In this case invalidate ** only those incrblob cursors open on that specific row. */ static void invalidateIncrblobCursors( Btree *pBtree, /* The database file to check */ Pgno pgnoRoot, /* The table that might be changing */ i64 iRow, /* The rowid that might be changing */ int isClearTable /* True if all rows are being deleted */ ){ BtCursor *p; if( pBtree->hasIncrblobCur==0 ) return; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(pBtree) ); pBtree->hasIncrblobCur = 0; for(p=pBtree->pBt->pCursor; p; p=p->pNext){ if( (p->curFlags & BTCF_Incrblob)!=0 ){ pBtree->hasIncrblobCur = 1; if( p->pgnoRoot==pgnoRoot && (isClearTable || p->info.nKey==iRow) ){ p->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; } } } } #else /* Stub function when INCRBLOB is omitted */ #define invalidateIncrblobCursors(w,x,y,z) #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB */ /* ** Set bit pgno of the BtShared.pHasContent bitvec. This is called ** when a page that previously contained data becomes a free-list leaf ** page. ** ** The BtShared.pHasContent bitvec exists to work around an obscure ** bug caused by the interaction of two useful IO optimizations surrounding ** free-list leaf pages: ** ** 1) When all data is deleted from a page and the page becomes ** a free-list leaf page, the page is not written to the database ** (as free-list leaf pages contain no meaningful data). Sometimes ** such a page is not even journalled (as it will not be modified, ** why bother journalling it?). ** ** 2) When a free-list leaf page is reused, its content is not read ** from the database or written to the journal file (why should it ** be, if it is not at all meaningful?). ** ** By themselves, these optimizations work fine and provide a handy ** performance boost to bulk delete or insert operations. However, if ** a page is moved to the free-list and then reused within the same ** transaction, a problem comes up. If the page is not journalled when ** it is moved to the free-list and it is also not journalled when it ** is extracted from the free-list and reused, then the original data ** may be lost. In the event of a rollback, it may not be possible ** to restore the database to its original configuration. ** ** The solution is the BtShared.pHasContent bitvec. Whenever a page is ** moved to become a free-list leaf page, the corresponding bit is ** set in the bitvec. Whenever a leaf page is extracted from the free-list, ** optimization 2 above is omitted if the corresponding bit is already ** set in BtShared.pHasContent. The contents of the bitvec are cleared ** at the end of every transaction. */ static int btreeSetHasContent(BtShared *pBt, Pgno pgno){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; if( !pBt->pHasContent ){ assert( pgno<=pBt->nPage ); pBt->pHasContent = sqlite3BitvecCreate(pBt->nPage); if( !pBt->pHasContent ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } } if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pgno<=sqlite3BitvecSize(pBt->pHasContent) ){ rc = sqlite3BitvecSet(pBt->pHasContent, pgno); } return rc; } /* ** Query the BtShared.pHasContent vector. ** ** This function is called when a free-list leaf page is removed from the ** free-list for reuse. It returns false if it is safe to retrieve the ** page from the pager layer with the 'no-content' flag set. True otherwise. */ static int btreeGetHasContent(BtShared *pBt, Pgno pgno){ Bitvec *p = pBt->pHasContent; return (p && (pgno>sqlite3BitvecSize(p) || sqlite3BitvecTest(p, pgno))); } /* ** Clear (destroy) the BtShared.pHasContent bitvec. This should be ** invoked at the conclusion of each write-transaction. */ static void btreeClearHasContent(BtShared *pBt){ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pBt->pHasContent); pBt->pHasContent = 0; } /* ** Release all of the apPage[] pages for a cursor. */ static void btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(BtCursor *pCur){ int i; if( pCur->iPage>=0 ){ for(i=0; iiPage; i++){ releasePageNotNull(pCur->apPage[i]); } releasePageNotNull(pCur->pPage); pCur->iPage = -1; } } /* ** The cursor passed as the only argument must point to a valid entry ** when this function is called (i.e. have eState==CURSOR_VALID). This ** function saves the current cursor key in variables pCur->nKey and ** pCur->pKey. SQLITE_OK is returned if successful or an SQLite error ** code otherwise. ** ** If the cursor is open on an intkey table, then the integer key ** (the rowid) is stored in pCur->nKey and pCur->pKey is left set to ** NULL. If the cursor is open on a non-intkey table, then pCur->pKey is ** set to point to a malloced buffer pCur->nKey bytes in size containing ** the key. */ static int saveCursorKey(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; assert( CURSOR_VALID==pCur->eState ); assert( 0==pCur->pKey ); assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); if( pCur->curIntKey ){ /* Only the rowid is required for a table btree */ pCur->nKey = sqlite3BtreeIntegerKey(pCur); }else{ /* For an index btree, save the complete key content. It is possible ** that the current key is corrupt. In that case, it is possible that ** the sqlite3VdbeRecordUnpack() function may overread the buffer by ** up to the size of 1 varint plus 1 8-byte value when the cursor ** position is restored. Hence the 17 bytes of padding allocated ** below. */ void *pKey; pCur->nKey = sqlite3BtreePayloadSize(pCur); pKey = sqlite3Malloc( pCur->nKey + 9 + 8 ); if( pKey ){ rc = sqlite3BtreePayload(pCur, 0, (int)pCur->nKey, pKey); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ pCur->pKey = pKey; }else{ sqlite3_free(pKey); } }else{ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } } assert( !pCur->curIntKey || !pCur->pKey ); return rc; } /* ** Save the current cursor position in the variables BtCursor.nKey ** and BtCursor.pKey. The cursor's state is set to CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK. ** ** The caller must ensure that the cursor is valid (has eState==CURSOR_VALID) ** prior to calling this routine. */ static int saveCursorPosition(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc; assert( CURSOR_VALID==pCur->eState || CURSOR_SKIPNEXT==pCur->eState ); assert( 0==pCur->pKey ); assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); if( pCur->eState==CURSOR_SKIPNEXT ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_VALID; }else{ pCur->skipNext = 0; } rc = saveCursorKey(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(pCur); pCur->eState = CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK; } pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_ValidNKey|BTCF_ValidOvfl|BTCF_AtLast); return rc; } /* Forward reference */ static int SQLITE_NOINLINE saveCursorsOnList(BtCursor*,Pgno,BtCursor*); /* ** Save the positions of all cursors (except pExcept) that are open on ** the table with root-page iRoot. "Saving the cursor position" means that ** the location in the btree is remembered in such a way that it can be ** moved back to the same spot after the btree has been modified. This ** routine is called just before cursor pExcept is used to modify the ** table, for example in BtreeDelete() or BtreeInsert(). ** ** If there are two or more cursors on the same btree, then all such ** cursors should have their BTCF_Multiple flag set. The btreeCursor() ** routine enforces that rule. This routine only needs to be called in ** the uncommon case when pExpect has the BTCF_Multiple flag set. ** ** If pExpect!=NULL and if no other cursors are found on the same root-page, ** then the BTCF_Multiple flag on pExpect is cleared, to avoid another ** pointless call to this routine. ** ** Implementation note: This routine merely checks to see if any cursors ** need to be saved. It calls out to saveCursorsOnList() in the (unusual) ** event that cursors are in need to being saved. */ static int saveAllCursors(BtShared *pBt, Pgno iRoot, BtCursor *pExcept){ BtCursor *p; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( pExcept==0 || pExcept->pBt==pBt ); for(p=pBt->pCursor; p; p=p->pNext){ if( p!=pExcept && (0==iRoot || p->pgnoRoot==iRoot) ) break; } if( p ) return saveCursorsOnList(p, iRoot, pExcept); if( pExcept ) pExcept->curFlags &= ~BTCF_Multiple; return SQLITE_OK; } /* This helper routine to saveAllCursors does the actual work of saving ** the cursors if and when a cursor is found that actually requires saving. ** The common case is that no cursors need to be saved, so this routine is ** broken out from its caller to avoid unnecessary stack pointer movement. */ static int SQLITE_NOINLINE saveCursorsOnList( BtCursor *p, /* The first cursor that needs saving */ Pgno iRoot, /* Only save cursor with this iRoot. Save all if zero */ BtCursor *pExcept /* Do not save this cursor */ ){ do{ if( p!=pExcept && (0==iRoot || p->pgnoRoot==iRoot) ){ if( p->eState==CURSOR_VALID || p->eState==CURSOR_SKIPNEXT ){ int rc = saveCursorPosition(p); if( SQLITE_OK!=rc ){ return rc; } }else{ testcase( p->iPage>=0 ); btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(p); } } p = p->pNext; }while( p ); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Clear the current cursor position. */ void sqlite3BtreeClearCursor(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); sqlite3_free(pCur->pKey); pCur->pKey = 0; pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; } /* ** In this version of BtreeMoveto, pKey is a packed index record ** such as is generated by the OP_MakeRecord opcode. Unpack the ** record and then call BtreeMovetoUnpacked() to do the work. */ static int btreeMoveto( BtCursor *pCur, /* Cursor open on the btree to be searched */ const void *pKey, /* Packed key if the btree is an index */ i64 nKey, /* Integer key for tables. Size of pKey for indices */ int bias, /* Bias search to the high end */ int *pRes /* Write search results here */ ){ int rc; /* Status code */ UnpackedRecord *pIdxKey; /* Unpacked index key */ if( pKey ){ assert( nKey==(i64)(int)nKey ); pIdxKey = sqlite3VdbeAllocUnpackedRecord(pCur->pKeyInfo); if( pIdxKey==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; sqlite3VdbeRecordUnpack(pCur->pKeyInfo, (int)nKey, pKey, pIdxKey); if( pIdxKey->nField==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto moveto_done; } }else{ pIdxKey = 0; } rc = sqlite3BtreeMovetoUnpacked(pCur, pIdxKey, nKey, bias, pRes); moveto_done: if( pIdxKey ){ sqlite3DbFree(pCur->pKeyInfo->db, pIdxKey); } return rc; } /* ** Restore the cursor to the position it was in (or as close to as possible) ** when saveCursorPosition() was called. Note that this call deletes the ** saved position info stored by saveCursorPosition(), so there can be ** at most one effective restoreCursorPosition() call after each ** saveCursorPosition(). */ static int btreeRestoreCursorPosition(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc; int skipNext; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState>=CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ); if( pCur->eState==CURSOR_FAULT ){ return pCur->skipNext; } pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; rc = btreeMoveto(pCur, pCur->pKey, pCur->nKey, 0, &skipNext); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ sqlite3_free(pCur->pKey); pCur->pKey = 0; assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID || pCur->eState==CURSOR_INVALID ); pCur->skipNext |= skipNext; if( pCur->skipNext && pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_SKIPNEXT; } } return rc; } #define restoreCursorPosition(p) \ (p->eState>=CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ? \ btreeRestoreCursorPosition(p) : \ SQLITE_OK) /* ** Determine whether or not a cursor has moved from the position where ** it was last placed, or has been invalidated for any other reason. ** Cursors can move when the row they are pointing at is deleted out ** from under them, for example. Cursor might also move if a btree ** is rebalanced. ** ** Calling this routine with a NULL cursor pointer returns false. ** ** Use the separate sqlite3BtreeCursorRestore() routine to restore a cursor ** back to where it ought to be if this routine returns true. */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorHasMoved(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(pCur) || pCur==sqlite3BtreeFakeValidCursor() ); assert( offsetof(BtCursor, eState)==0 ); assert( sizeof(pCur->eState)==1 ); return CURSOR_VALID != *(u8*)pCur; } /* ** Return a pointer to a fake BtCursor object that will always answer ** false to the sqlite3BtreeCursorHasMoved() routine above. The fake ** cursor returned must not be used with any other Btree interface. */ BtCursor *sqlite3BtreeFakeValidCursor(void){ static u8 fakeCursor = CURSOR_VALID; assert( offsetof(BtCursor, eState)==0 ); return (BtCursor*)&fakeCursor; } /* ** This routine restores a cursor back to its original position after it ** has been moved by some outside activity (such as a btree rebalance or ** a row having been deleted out from under the cursor). ** ** On success, the *pDifferentRow parameter is false if the cursor is left ** pointing at exactly the same row. *pDifferntRow is the row the cursor ** was pointing to has been deleted, forcing the cursor to point to some ** nearby row. ** ** This routine should only be called for a cursor that just returned ** TRUE from sqlite3BtreeCursorHasMoved(). */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorRestore(BtCursor *pCur, int *pDifferentRow){ int rc; assert( pCur!=0 ); assert( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ); rc = restoreCursorPosition(pCur); if( rc ){ *pDifferentRow = 1; return rc; } if( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ){ *pDifferentRow = 1; }else{ assert( pCur->skipNext==0 ); *pDifferentRow = 0; } return SQLITE_OK; } #ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS /* ** Provide hints to the cursor. The particular hint given (and the type ** and number of the varargs parameters) is determined by the eHintType ** parameter. See the definitions of the BTREE_HINT_* macros for details. */ void sqlite3BtreeCursorHint(BtCursor *pCur, int eHintType, ...){ /* Used only by system that substitute their own storage engine */ } #endif /* ** Provide flag hints to the cursor. */ void sqlite3BtreeCursorHintFlags(BtCursor *pCur, unsigned x){ assert( x==BTREE_SEEK_EQ || x==BTREE_BULKLOAD || x==0 ); pCur->hints = x; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* ** Given a page number of a regular database page, return the page ** number for the pointer-map page that contains the entry for the ** input page number. ** ** Return 0 (not a valid page) for pgno==1 since there is ** no pointer map associated with page 1. The integrity_check logic ** requires that ptrmapPageno(*,1)!=1. */ static Pgno ptrmapPageno(BtShared *pBt, Pgno pgno){ int nPagesPerMapPage; Pgno iPtrMap, ret; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); if( pgno<2 ) return 0; nPagesPerMapPage = (pBt->usableSize/5)+1; iPtrMap = (pgno-2)/nPagesPerMapPage; ret = (iPtrMap*nPagesPerMapPage) + 2; if( ret==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ ret++; } return ret; } /* ** Write an entry into the pointer map. ** ** This routine updates the pointer map entry for page number 'key' ** so that it maps to type 'eType' and parent page number 'pgno'. ** ** If *pRC is initially non-zero (non-SQLITE_OK) then this routine is ** a no-op. If an error occurs, the appropriate error code is written ** into *pRC. */ static void ptrmapPut(BtShared *pBt, Pgno key, u8 eType, Pgno parent, int *pRC){ DbPage *pDbPage; /* The pointer map page */ u8 *pPtrmap; /* The pointer map data */ Pgno iPtrmap; /* The pointer map page number */ int offset; /* Offset in pointer map page */ int rc; /* Return code from subfunctions */ if( *pRC ) return; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); /* The master-journal page number must never be used as a pointer map page */ assert( 0==PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt)) ); assert( pBt->autoVacuum ); if( key==0 ){ *pRC = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; return; } iPtrmap = PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, key); rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pBt->pPager, iPtrmap, &pDbPage, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ *pRC = rc; return; } if( ((char*)sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pDbPage))[0]!=0 ){ /* The first byte of the extra data is the MemPage.isInit byte. ** If that byte is set, it means this page is also being used ** as a btree page. */ *pRC = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto ptrmap_exit; } offset = PTRMAP_PTROFFSET(iPtrmap, key); if( offset<0 ){ *pRC = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto ptrmap_exit; } assert( offset <= (int)pBt->usableSize-5 ); pPtrmap = (u8 *)sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage); if( eType!=pPtrmap[offset] || get4byte(&pPtrmap[offset+1])!=parent ){ TRACE(("PTRMAP_UPDATE: %d->(%d,%d)\n", key, eType, parent)); *pRC= rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ pPtrmap[offset] = eType; put4byte(&pPtrmap[offset+1], parent); } } ptrmap_exit: sqlite3PagerUnref(pDbPage); } /* ** Read an entry from the pointer map. ** ** This routine retrieves the pointer map entry for page 'key', writing ** the type and parent page number to *pEType and *pPgno respectively. ** An error code is returned if something goes wrong, otherwise SQLITE_OK. */ static int ptrmapGet(BtShared *pBt, Pgno key, u8 *pEType, Pgno *pPgno){ DbPage *pDbPage; /* The pointer map page */ int iPtrmap; /* Pointer map page index */ u8 *pPtrmap; /* Pointer map page data */ int offset; /* Offset of entry in pointer map */ int rc; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); iPtrmap = PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, key); rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pBt->pPager, iPtrmap, &pDbPage, 0); if( rc!=0 ){ return rc; } pPtrmap = (u8 *)sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage); offset = PTRMAP_PTROFFSET(iPtrmap, key); if( offset<0 ){ sqlite3PagerUnref(pDbPage); return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } assert( offset <= (int)pBt->usableSize-5 ); assert( pEType!=0 ); *pEType = pPtrmap[offset]; if( pPgno ) *pPgno = get4byte(&pPtrmap[offset+1]); sqlite3PagerUnref(pDbPage); if( *pEType<1 || *pEType>5 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(iPtrmap); return SQLITE_OK; } #else /* if defined SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM */ #define ptrmapPut(w,x,y,z,rc) #define ptrmapGet(w,x,y,z) SQLITE_OK #define ptrmapPutOvflPtr(x, y, rc) #endif /* ** Given a btree page and a cell index (0 means the first cell on ** the page, 1 means the second cell, and so forth) return a pointer ** to the cell content. ** ** findCellPastPtr() does the same except it skips past the initial ** 4-byte child pointer found on interior pages, if there is one. ** ** This routine works only for pages that do not contain overflow cells. */ #define findCell(P,I) \ ((P)->aData + ((P)->maskPage & get2byteAligned(&(P)->aCellIdx[2*(I)]))) #define findCellPastPtr(P,I) \ ((P)->aDataOfst + ((P)->maskPage & get2byteAligned(&(P)->aCellIdx[2*(I)]))) /* ** This is common tail processing for btreeParseCellPtr() and ** btreeParseCellPtrIndex() for the case when the cell does not fit entirely ** on a single B-tree page. Make necessary adjustments to the CellInfo ** structure. */ static SQLITE_NOINLINE void btreeParseCellAdjustSizeForOverflow( MemPage *pPage, /* Page containing the cell */ u8 *pCell, /* Pointer to the cell text. */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Fill in this structure */ ){ /* If the payload will not fit completely on the local page, we have ** to decide how much to store locally and how much to spill onto ** overflow pages. The strategy is to minimize the amount of unused ** space on overflow pages while keeping the amount of local storage ** in between minLocal and maxLocal. ** ** Warning: changing the way overflow payload is distributed in any ** way will result in an incompatible file format. */ int minLocal; /* Minimum amount of payload held locally */ int maxLocal; /* Maximum amount of payload held locally */ int surplus; /* Overflow payload available for local storage */ minLocal = pPage->minLocal; maxLocal = pPage->maxLocal; surplus = minLocal + (pInfo->nPayload - minLocal)%(pPage->pBt->usableSize-4); testcase( surplus==maxLocal ); testcase( surplus==maxLocal+1 ); if( surplus <= maxLocal ){ pInfo->nLocal = (u16)surplus; }else{ pInfo->nLocal = (u16)minLocal; } pInfo->nSize = (u16)(&pInfo->pPayload[pInfo->nLocal] - pCell) + 4; } /* ** The following routines are implementations of the MemPage.xParseCell() ** method. ** ** Parse a cell content block and fill in the CellInfo structure. ** ** btreeParseCellPtr() => table btree leaf nodes ** btreeParseCellNoPayload() => table btree internal nodes ** btreeParseCellPtrIndex() => index btree nodes ** ** There is also a wrapper function btreeParseCell() that works for ** all MemPage types and that references the cell by index rather than ** by pointer. */ static void btreeParseCellPtrNoPayload( MemPage *pPage, /* Page containing the cell */ u8 *pCell, /* Pointer to the cell text. */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Fill in this structure */ ){ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( pPage->leaf==0 ); assert( pPage->childPtrSize==4 ); #ifndef SQLITE_DEBUG UNUSED_PARAMETER(pPage); #endif pInfo->nSize = 4 + getVarint(&pCell[4], (u64*)&pInfo->nKey); pInfo->nPayload = 0; pInfo->nLocal = 0; pInfo->pPayload = 0; return; } static void btreeParseCellPtr( MemPage *pPage, /* Page containing the cell */ u8 *pCell, /* Pointer to the cell text. */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Fill in this structure */ ){ u8 *pIter; /* For scanning through pCell */ u32 nPayload; /* Number of bytes of cell payload */ u64 iKey; /* Extracted Key value */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( pPage->leaf==0 || pPage->leaf==1 ); assert( pPage->intKeyLeaf ); assert( pPage->childPtrSize==0 ); pIter = pCell; /* The next block of code is equivalent to: ** ** pIter += getVarint32(pIter, nPayload); ** ** The code is inlined to avoid a function call. */ nPayload = *pIter; if( nPayload>=0x80 ){ u8 *pEnd = &pIter[8]; nPayload &= 0x7f; do{ nPayload = (nPayload<<7) | (*++pIter & 0x7f); }while( (*pIter)>=0x80 && pIternKey); ** ** The code is inlined to avoid a function call. */ iKey = *pIter; if( iKey>=0x80 ){ u8 *pEnd = &pIter[7]; iKey &= 0x7f; while(1){ iKey = (iKey<<7) | (*++pIter & 0x7f); if( (*pIter)<0x80 ) break; if( pIter>=pEnd ){ iKey = (iKey<<8) | *++pIter; break; } } } pIter++; pInfo->nKey = *(i64*)&iKey; pInfo->nPayload = nPayload; pInfo->pPayload = pIter; testcase( nPayload==pPage->maxLocal ); testcase( nPayload==pPage->maxLocal+1 ); if( nPayload<=pPage->maxLocal ){ /* This is the (easy) common case where the entire payload fits ** on the local page. No overflow is required. */ pInfo->nSize = nPayload + (u16)(pIter - pCell); if( pInfo->nSize<4 ) pInfo->nSize = 4; pInfo->nLocal = (u16)nPayload; }else{ btreeParseCellAdjustSizeForOverflow(pPage, pCell, pInfo); } } static void btreeParseCellPtrIndex( MemPage *pPage, /* Page containing the cell */ u8 *pCell, /* Pointer to the cell text. */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Fill in this structure */ ){ u8 *pIter; /* For scanning through pCell */ u32 nPayload; /* Number of bytes of cell payload */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( pPage->leaf==0 || pPage->leaf==1 ); assert( pPage->intKeyLeaf==0 ); pIter = pCell + pPage->childPtrSize; nPayload = *pIter; if( nPayload>=0x80 ){ u8 *pEnd = &pIter[8]; nPayload &= 0x7f; do{ nPayload = (nPayload<<7) | (*++pIter & 0x7f); }while( *(pIter)>=0x80 && pIternKey = nPayload; pInfo->nPayload = nPayload; pInfo->pPayload = pIter; testcase( nPayload==pPage->maxLocal ); testcase( nPayload==pPage->maxLocal+1 ); if( nPayload<=pPage->maxLocal ){ /* This is the (easy) common case where the entire payload fits ** on the local page. No overflow is required. */ pInfo->nSize = nPayload + (u16)(pIter - pCell); if( pInfo->nSize<4 ) pInfo->nSize = 4; pInfo->nLocal = (u16)nPayload; }else{ btreeParseCellAdjustSizeForOverflow(pPage, pCell, pInfo); } } static void btreeParseCell( MemPage *pPage, /* Page containing the cell */ int iCell, /* The cell index. First cell is 0 */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Fill in this structure */ ){ pPage->xParseCell(pPage, findCell(pPage, iCell), pInfo); } /* ** The following routines are implementations of the MemPage.xCellSize ** method. ** ** Compute the total number of bytes that a Cell needs in the cell ** data area of the btree-page. The return number includes the cell ** data header and the local payload, but not any overflow page or ** the space used by the cell pointer. ** ** cellSizePtrNoPayload() => table internal nodes ** cellSizePtr() => all index nodes & table leaf nodes */ static u16 cellSizePtr(MemPage *pPage, u8 *pCell){ u8 *pIter = pCell + pPage->childPtrSize; /* For looping over bytes of pCell */ u8 *pEnd; /* End mark for a varint */ u32 nSize; /* Size value to return */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* The value returned by this function should always be the same as ** the (CellInfo.nSize) value found by doing a full parse of the ** cell. If SQLITE_DEBUG is defined, an assert() at the bottom of ** this function verifies that this invariant is not violated. */ CellInfo debuginfo; pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, &debuginfo); #endif nSize = *pIter; if( nSize>=0x80 ){ pEnd = &pIter[8]; nSize &= 0x7f; do{ nSize = (nSize<<7) | (*++pIter & 0x7f); }while( *(pIter)>=0x80 && pIterintKey ){ /* pIter now points at the 64-bit integer key value, a variable length ** integer. The following block moves pIter to point at the first byte ** past the end of the key value. */ pEnd = &pIter[9]; while( (*pIter++)&0x80 && pItermaxLocal ); testcase( nSize==pPage->maxLocal+1 ); if( nSize<=pPage->maxLocal ){ nSize += (u32)(pIter - pCell); if( nSize<4 ) nSize = 4; }else{ int minLocal = pPage->minLocal; nSize = minLocal + (nSize - minLocal) % (pPage->pBt->usableSize - 4); testcase( nSize==pPage->maxLocal ); testcase( nSize==pPage->maxLocal+1 ); if( nSize>pPage->maxLocal ){ nSize = minLocal; } nSize += 4 + (u16)(pIter - pCell); } assert( nSize==debuginfo.nSize || CORRUPT_DB ); return (u16)nSize; } static u16 cellSizePtrNoPayload(MemPage *pPage, u8 *pCell){ u8 *pIter = pCell + 4; /* For looping over bytes of pCell */ u8 *pEnd; /* End mark for a varint */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* The value returned by this function should always be the same as ** the (CellInfo.nSize) value found by doing a full parse of the ** cell. If SQLITE_DEBUG is defined, an assert() at the bottom of ** this function verifies that this invariant is not violated. */ CellInfo debuginfo; pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, &debuginfo); #else UNUSED_PARAMETER(pPage); #endif assert( pPage->childPtrSize==4 ); pEnd = pIter + 9; while( (*pIter++)&0x80 && pIterxCellSize(pPage, findCell(pPage, iCell)); } #endif #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* ** If the cell pCell, part of page pPage contains a pointer ** to an overflow page, insert an entry into the pointer-map ** for the overflow page. */ static void ptrmapPutOvflPtr(MemPage *pPage, u8 *pCell, int *pRC){ CellInfo info; if( *pRC ) return; assert( pCell!=0 ); pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, &info); if( info.nLocalaDataEnd, pCell, pCell+info.nLocal) ){ *pRC = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; return; } ovfl = get4byte(&pCell[info.nSize-4]); ptrmapPut(pPage->pBt, ovfl, PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1, pPage->pgno, pRC); } } #endif /* ** Defragment the page given. This routine reorganizes cells within the ** page so that there are no free-blocks on the free-block list. ** ** Parameter nMaxFrag is the maximum amount of fragmented space that may be ** present in the page after this routine returns. ** ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-44582-60138 SQLite may from time to time reorganize a ** b-tree page so that there are no freeblocks or fragment bytes, all ** unused bytes are contained in the unallocated space region, and all ** cells are packed tightly at the end of the page. */ static int defragmentPage(MemPage *pPage, int nMaxFrag){ int i; /* Loop counter */ int pc; /* Address of the i-th cell */ int hdr; /* Offset to the page header */ int size; /* Size of a cell */ int usableSize; /* Number of usable bytes on a page */ int cellOffset; /* Offset to the cell pointer array */ int cbrk; /* Offset to the cell content area */ int nCell; /* Number of cells on the page */ unsigned char *data; /* The page data */ unsigned char *temp; /* Temp area for cell content */ unsigned char *src; /* Source of content */ int iCellFirst; /* First allowable cell index */ int iCellLast; /* Last possible cell index */ assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->pBt!=0 ); assert( pPage->pBt->usableSize <= SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE ); assert( pPage->nOverflow==0 ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); temp = 0; src = data = pPage->aData; hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; cellOffset = pPage->cellOffset; nCell = pPage->nCell; assert( nCell==get2byte(&data[hdr+3]) ); iCellFirst = cellOffset + 2*nCell; usableSize = pPage->pBt->usableSize; /* This block handles pages with two or fewer free blocks and nMaxFrag ** or fewer fragmented bytes. In this case it is faster to move the ** two (or one) blocks of cells using memmove() and add the required ** offsets to each pointer in the cell-pointer array than it is to ** reconstruct the entire page. */ if( (int)data[hdr+7]<=nMaxFrag ){ int iFree = get2byte(&data[hdr+1]); /* If the initial freeblock offset were out of bounds, that would ** have been detected by btreeInitPage() when it was computing the ** number of free bytes on the page. */ assert( iFree<=usableSize-4 ); if( iFree ){ int iFree2 = get2byte(&data[iFree]); if( iFree2>usableSize-4 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); if( 0==iFree2 || (data[iFree2]==0 && data[iFree2+1]==0) ){ u8 *pEnd = &data[cellOffset + nCell*2]; u8 *pAddr; int sz2 = 0; int sz = get2byte(&data[iFree+2]); int top = get2byte(&data[hdr+5]); if( top>=iFree ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } if( iFree2 ){ if( iFree+sz>iFree2 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); sz2 = get2byte(&data[iFree2+2]); if( iFree2+sz2 > usableSize ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); memmove(&data[iFree+sz+sz2], &data[iFree+sz], iFree2-(iFree+sz)); sz += sz2; } cbrk = top+sz; assert( cbrk+(iFree-top) <= usableSize ); memmove(&data[cbrk], &data[top], iFree-top); for(pAddr=&data[cellOffset]; pAddriCellLast ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } assert( pc>=iCellFirst && pc<=iCellLast ); size = pPage->xCellSize(pPage, &src[pc]); cbrk -= size; if( cbrkusableSize ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } assert( cbrk+size<=usableSize && cbrk>=iCellFirst ); testcase( cbrk+size==usableSize ); testcase( pc+size==usableSize ); put2byte(pAddr, cbrk); if( temp==0 ){ int x; if( cbrk==pc ) continue; temp = sqlite3PagerTempSpace(pPage->pBt->pPager); x = get2byte(&data[hdr+5]); memcpy(&temp[x], &data[x], (cbrk+size) - x); src = temp; } memcpy(&data[cbrk], &src[pc], size); } data[hdr+7] = 0; defragment_out: if( data[hdr+7]+cbrk-iCellFirst!=pPage->nFree ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } assert( cbrk>=iCellFirst ); put2byte(&data[hdr+5], cbrk); data[hdr+1] = 0; data[hdr+2] = 0; memset(&data[iCellFirst], 0, cbrk-iCellFirst); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Search the free-list on page pPg for space to store a cell nByte bytes in ** size. If one can be found, return a pointer to the space and remove it ** from the free-list. ** ** If no suitable space can be found on the free-list, return NULL. ** ** This function may detect corruption within pPg. If corruption is ** detected then *pRc is set to SQLITE_CORRUPT and NULL is returned. ** ** Slots on the free list that are between 1 and 3 bytes larger than nByte ** will be ignored if adding the extra space to the fragmentation count ** causes the fragmentation count to exceed 60. */ static u8 *pageFindSlot(MemPage *pPg, int nByte, int *pRc){ const int hdr = pPg->hdrOffset; u8 * const aData = pPg->aData; int iAddr = hdr + 1; int pc = get2byte(&aData[iAddr]); int x; int usableSize = pPg->pBt->usableSize; int size; /* Size of the free slot */ assert( pc>0 ); while( pc<=usableSize-4 ){ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-22710-53328 The third and fourth bytes of each ** freeblock form a big-endian integer which is the size of the freeblock ** in bytes, including the 4-byte header. */ size = get2byte(&aData[pc+2]); if( (x = size - nByte)>=0 ){ testcase( x==4 ); testcase( x==3 ); if( size+pc > usableSize ){ *pRc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPg); return 0; }else if( x<4 ){ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-11498-58022 In a well-formed b-tree page, the total ** number of bytes in fragments may not exceed 60. */ if( aData[hdr+7]>57 ) return 0; /* Remove the slot from the free-list. Update the number of ** fragmented bytes within the page. */ memcpy(&aData[iAddr], &aData[pc], 2); aData[hdr+7] += (u8)x; }else{ /* The slot remains on the free-list. Reduce its size to account ** for the portion used by the new allocation. */ put2byte(&aData[pc+2], x); } return &aData[pc + x]; } iAddr = pc; pc = get2byte(&aData[pc]); if( pcaData[] ** of the first byte of allocated space. Return either SQLITE_OK or ** an error code (usually SQLITE_CORRUPT). ** ** The caller guarantees that there is sufficient space to make the ** allocation. This routine might need to defragment in order to bring ** all the space together, however. This routine will avoid using ** the first two bytes past the cell pointer area since presumably this ** allocation is being made in order to insert a new cell, so we will ** also end up needing a new cell pointer. */ static int allocateSpace(MemPage *pPage, int nByte, int *pIdx){ const int hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; /* Local cache of pPage->hdrOffset */ u8 * const data = pPage->aData; /* Local cache of pPage->aData */ int top; /* First byte of cell content area */ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Integer return code */ int gap; /* First byte of gap between cell pointers and cell content */ assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->pBt ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( nByte>=0 ); /* Minimum cell size is 4 */ assert( pPage->nFree>=nByte ); assert( pPage->nOverflow==0 ); assert( nByte < (int)(pPage->pBt->usableSize-8) ); assert( pPage->cellOffset == hdr + 12 - 4*pPage->leaf ); gap = pPage->cellOffset + 2*pPage->nCell; assert( gap<=65536 ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-29356-02391 If the database uses a 65536-byte page size ** and the reserved space is zero (the usual value for reserved space) ** then the cell content offset of an empty page wants to be 65536. ** However, that integer is too large to be stored in a 2-byte unsigned ** integer, so a value of 0 is used in its place. */ top = get2byte(&data[hdr+5]); assert( top<=(int)pPage->pBt->usableSize ); /* Prevent by getAndInitPage() */ if( gap>top ){ if( top==0 && pPage->pBt->usableSize==65536 ){ top = 65536; }else{ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } } /* If there is enough space between gap and top for one more cell pointer ** array entry offset, and if the freelist is not empty, then search the ** freelist looking for a free slot big enough to satisfy the request. */ testcase( gap+2==top ); testcase( gap+1==top ); testcase( gap==top ); if( (data[hdr+2] || data[hdr+1]) && gap+2<=top ){ u8 *pSpace = pageFindSlot(pPage, nByte, &rc); if( pSpace ){ assert( pSpace>=data && (pSpace - data)<65536 ); *pIdx = (int)(pSpace - data); return SQLITE_OK; }else if( rc ){ return rc; } } /* The request could not be fulfilled using a freelist slot. Check ** to see if defragmentation is necessary. */ testcase( gap+2+nByte==top ); if( gap+2+nByte>top ){ assert( pPage->nCell>0 || CORRUPT_DB ); rc = defragmentPage(pPage, MIN(4, pPage->nFree - (2+nByte))); if( rc ) return rc; top = get2byteNotZero(&data[hdr+5]); assert( gap+2+nByte<=top ); } /* Allocate memory from the gap in between the cell pointer array ** and the cell content area. The btreeInitPage() call has already ** validated the freelist. Given that the freelist is valid, there ** is no way that the allocation can extend off the end of the page. ** The assert() below verifies the previous sentence. */ top -= nByte; put2byte(&data[hdr+5], top); assert( top+nByte <= (int)pPage->pBt->usableSize ); *pIdx = top; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Return a section of the pPage->aData to the freelist. ** The first byte of the new free block is pPage->aData[iStart] ** and the size of the block is iSize bytes. ** ** Adjacent freeblocks are coalesced. ** ** Note that even though the freeblock list was checked by btreeInitPage(), ** that routine will not detect overlap between cells or freeblocks. Nor ** does it detect cells or freeblocks that encrouch into the reserved bytes ** at the end of the page. So do additional corruption checks inside this ** routine and return SQLITE_CORRUPT if any problems are found. */ static int freeSpace(MemPage *pPage, u16 iStart, u16 iSize){ u16 iPtr; /* Address of ptr to next freeblock */ u16 iFreeBlk; /* Address of the next freeblock */ u8 hdr; /* Page header size. 0 or 100 */ u8 nFrag = 0; /* Reduction in fragmentation */ u16 iOrigSize = iSize; /* Original value of iSize */ u16 x; /* Offset to cell content area */ u32 iEnd = iStart + iSize; /* First byte past the iStart buffer */ unsigned char *data = pPage->aData; /* Page content */ assert( pPage->pBt!=0 ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( CORRUPT_DB || iStart>=pPage->hdrOffset+6+pPage->childPtrSize ); assert( CORRUPT_DB || iEnd <= pPage->pBt->usableSize ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( iSize>=4 ); /* Minimum cell size is 4 */ assert( iStart<=pPage->pBt->usableSize-4 ); /* The list of freeblocks must be in ascending order. Find the ** spot on the list where iStart should be inserted. */ hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; iPtr = hdr + 1; if( data[iPtr+1]==0 && data[iPtr]==0 ){ iFreeBlk = 0; /* Shortcut for the case when the freelist is empty */ }else{ while( (iFreeBlk = get2byte(&data[iPtr]))pPage->pBt->usableSize-4 ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } assert( iFreeBlk>iPtr || iFreeBlk==0 ); /* At this point: ** iFreeBlk: First freeblock after iStart, or zero if none ** iPtr: The address of a pointer to iFreeBlk ** ** Check to see if iFreeBlk should be coalesced onto the end of iStart. */ if( iFreeBlk && iEnd+3>=iFreeBlk ){ nFrag = iFreeBlk - iEnd; if( iEnd>iFreeBlk ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); iEnd = iFreeBlk + get2byte(&data[iFreeBlk+2]); if( iEnd > pPage->pBt->usableSize ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } iSize = iEnd - iStart; iFreeBlk = get2byte(&data[iFreeBlk]); } /* If iPtr is another freeblock (that is, if iPtr is not the freelist ** pointer in the page header) then check to see if iStart should be ** coalesced onto the end of iPtr. */ if( iPtr>hdr+1 ){ int iPtrEnd = iPtr + get2byte(&data[iPtr+2]); if( iPtrEnd+3>=iStart ){ if( iPtrEnd>iStart ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); nFrag += iStart - iPtrEnd; iSize = iEnd - iPtr; iStart = iPtr; } } if( nFrag>data[hdr+7] ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); data[hdr+7] -= nFrag; } x = get2byte(&data[hdr+5]); if( iStart<=x ){ /* The new freeblock is at the beginning of the cell content area, ** so just extend the cell content area rather than create another ** freelist entry */ if( iStartpBt->btsFlags & BTS_FAST_SECURE ){ /* Overwrite deleted information with zeros when the secure_delete ** option is enabled */ memset(&data[iStart], 0, iSize); } put2byte(&data[iStart], iFreeBlk); put2byte(&data[iStart+2], iSize); pPage->nFree += iOrigSize; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Decode the flags byte (the first byte of the header) for a page ** and initialize fields of the MemPage structure accordingly. ** ** Only the following combinations are supported. Anything different ** indicates a corrupt database files: ** ** PTF_ZERODATA ** PTF_ZERODATA | PTF_LEAF ** PTF_LEAFDATA | PTF_INTKEY ** PTF_LEAFDATA | PTF_INTKEY | PTF_LEAF */ static int decodeFlags(MemPage *pPage, int flagByte){ BtShared *pBt; /* A copy of pPage->pBt */ assert( pPage->hdrOffset==(pPage->pgno==1 ? 100 : 0) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); pPage->leaf = (u8)(flagByte>>3); assert( PTF_LEAF == 1<<3 ); flagByte &= ~PTF_LEAF; pPage->childPtrSize = 4-4*pPage->leaf; pPage->xCellSize = cellSizePtr; pBt = pPage->pBt; if( flagByte==(PTF_LEAFDATA | PTF_INTKEY) ){ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-07291-35328 A value of 5 (0x05) means the page is an ** interior table b-tree page. */ assert( (PTF_LEAFDATA|PTF_INTKEY)==5 ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-26900-09176 A value of 13 (0x0d) means the page is a ** leaf table b-tree page. */ assert( (PTF_LEAFDATA|PTF_INTKEY|PTF_LEAF)==13 ); pPage->intKey = 1; if( pPage->leaf ){ pPage->intKeyLeaf = 1; pPage->xParseCell = btreeParseCellPtr; }else{ pPage->intKeyLeaf = 0; pPage->xCellSize = cellSizePtrNoPayload; pPage->xParseCell = btreeParseCellPtrNoPayload; } pPage->maxLocal = pBt->maxLeaf; pPage->minLocal = pBt->minLeaf; }else if( flagByte==PTF_ZERODATA ){ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-43316-37308 A value of 2 (0x02) means the page is an ** interior index b-tree page. */ assert( (PTF_ZERODATA)==2 ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-59615-42828 A value of 10 (0x0a) means the page is a ** leaf index b-tree page. */ assert( (PTF_ZERODATA|PTF_LEAF)==10 ); pPage->intKey = 0; pPage->intKeyLeaf = 0; pPage->xParseCell = btreeParseCellPtrIndex; pPage->maxLocal = pBt->maxLocal; pPage->minLocal = pBt->minLocal; }else{ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-47608-56469 Any other value for the b-tree page type is ** an error. */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } pPage->max1bytePayload = pBt->max1bytePayload; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Initialize the auxiliary information for a disk block. ** ** Return SQLITE_OK on success. If we see that the page does ** not contain a well-formed database page, then return ** SQLITE_CORRUPT. Note that a return of SQLITE_OK does not ** guarantee that the page is well-formed. It only shows that ** we failed to detect any corruption. */ static int btreeInitPage(MemPage *pPage){ int pc; /* Address of a freeblock within pPage->aData[] */ u8 hdr; /* Offset to beginning of page header */ u8 *data; /* Equal to pPage->aData */ BtShared *pBt; /* The main btree structure */ int usableSize; /* Amount of usable space on each page */ u16 cellOffset; /* Offset from start of page to first cell pointer */ int nFree; /* Number of unused bytes on the page */ int top; /* First byte of the cell content area */ int iCellFirst; /* First allowable cell or freeblock offset */ int iCellLast; /* Last possible cell or freeblock offset */ assert( pPage->pBt!=0 ); assert( pPage->pBt->db!=0 ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( pPage->pgno==sqlite3PagerPagenumber(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage == sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->aData == sqlite3PagerGetData(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->isInit==0 ); pBt = pPage->pBt; hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; data = pPage->aData; /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-28594-02890 The one-byte flag at offset 0 indicating ** the b-tree page type. */ if( decodeFlags(pPage, data[hdr]) ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } assert( pBt->pageSize>=512 && pBt->pageSize<=65536 ); pPage->maskPage = (u16)(pBt->pageSize - 1); pPage->nOverflow = 0; usableSize = pBt->usableSize; pPage->cellOffset = cellOffset = hdr + 8 + pPage->childPtrSize; pPage->aDataEnd = &data[usableSize]; pPage->aCellIdx = &data[cellOffset]; pPage->aDataOfst = &data[pPage->childPtrSize]; /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-58015-48175 The two-byte integer at offset 5 designates ** the start of the cell content area. A zero value for this integer is ** interpreted as 65536. */ top = get2byteNotZero(&data[hdr+5]); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-37002-32774 The two-byte integer at offset 3 gives the ** number of cells on the page. */ pPage->nCell = get2byte(&data[hdr+3]); if( pPage->nCell>MX_CELL(pBt) ){ /* To many cells for a single page. The page must be corrupt */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } testcase( pPage->nCell==MX_CELL(pBt) ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-24089-57979 If a page contains no cells (which is only ** possible for a root page of a table that contains no rows) then the ** offset to the cell content area will equal the page size minus the ** bytes of reserved space. */ assert( pPage->nCell>0 || top==usableSize || CORRUPT_DB ); /* A malformed database page might cause us to read past the end ** of page when parsing a cell. ** ** The following block of code checks early to see if a cell extends ** past the end of a page boundary and causes SQLITE_CORRUPT to be ** returned if it does. */ iCellFirst = cellOffset + 2*pPage->nCell; iCellLast = usableSize - 4; if( pBt->db->flags & SQLITE_CellSizeCk ){ int i; /* Index into the cell pointer array */ int sz; /* Size of a cell */ if( !pPage->leaf ) iCellLast--; for(i=0; inCell; i++){ pc = get2byteAligned(&data[cellOffset+i*2]); testcase( pc==iCellFirst ); testcase( pc==iCellLast ); if( pciCellLast ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } sz = pPage->xCellSize(pPage, &data[pc]); testcase( pc+sz==usableSize ); if( pc+sz>usableSize ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } } if( !pPage->leaf ) iCellLast++; } /* Compute the total free space on the page ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-23588-34450 The two-byte integer at offset 1 gives the ** start of the first freeblock on the page, or is zero if there are no ** freeblocks. */ pc = get2byte(&data[hdr+1]); nFree = data[hdr+7] + top; /* Init nFree to non-freeblock free space */ if( pc>0 ){ u32 next, size; if( pciCellLast ){ /* Freeblock off the end of the page */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } next = get2byte(&data[pc]); size = get2byte(&data[pc+2]); nFree = nFree + size; if( next<=pc+size+3 ) break; pc = next; } if( next>0 ){ /* Freeblock not in ascending order */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } if( pc+size>(unsigned int)usableSize ){ /* Last freeblock extends past page end */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } } /* At this point, nFree contains the sum of the offset to the start ** of the cell-content area plus the number of free bytes within ** the cell-content area. If this is greater than the usable-size ** of the page, then the page must be corrupted. This check also ** serves to verify that the offset to the start of the cell-content ** area, according to the page header, lies within the page. */ if( nFree>usableSize ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } pPage->nFree = (u16)(nFree - iCellFirst); pPage->isInit = 1; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Set up a raw page so that it looks like a database page holding ** no entries. */ static void zeroPage(MemPage *pPage, int flags){ unsigned char *data = pPage->aData; BtShared *pBt = pPage->pBt; u8 hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; u16 first; assert( sqlite3PagerPagenumber(pPage->pDbPage)==pPage->pgno ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pPage->pDbPage) == (void*)pPage ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetData(pPage->pDbPage) == data ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); if( pBt->btsFlags & BTS_FAST_SECURE ){ memset(&data[hdr], 0, pBt->usableSize - hdr); } data[hdr] = (char)flags; first = hdr + ((flags&PTF_LEAF)==0 ? 12 : 8); memset(&data[hdr+1], 0, 4); data[hdr+7] = 0; put2byte(&data[hdr+5], pBt->usableSize); pPage->nFree = (u16)(pBt->usableSize - first); decodeFlags(pPage, flags); pPage->cellOffset = first; pPage->aDataEnd = &data[pBt->usableSize]; pPage->aCellIdx = &data[first]; pPage->aDataOfst = &data[pPage->childPtrSize]; pPage->nOverflow = 0; assert( pBt->pageSize>=512 && pBt->pageSize<=65536 ); pPage->maskPage = (u16)(pBt->pageSize - 1); pPage->nCell = 0; pPage->isInit = 1; } /* ** Convert a DbPage obtained from the pager into a MemPage used by ** the btree layer. */ static MemPage *btreePageFromDbPage(DbPage *pDbPage, Pgno pgno, BtShared *pBt){ MemPage *pPage = (MemPage*)sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pDbPage); if( pgno!=pPage->pgno ){ pPage->aData = sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage); pPage->pDbPage = pDbPage; pPage->pBt = pBt; pPage->pgno = pgno; pPage->hdrOffset = pgno==1 ? 100 : 0; } assert( pPage->aData==sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage) ); return pPage; } /* ** Get a page from the pager. Initialize the MemPage.pBt and ** MemPage.aData elements if needed. See also: btreeGetUnusedPage(). ** ** If the PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT flag is set, it means that we do not care ** about the content of the page at this time. So do not go to the disk ** to fetch the content. Just fill in the content with zeros for now. ** If in the future we call sqlite3PagerWrite() on this page, that ** means we have started to be concerned about content and the disk ** read should occur at that point. */ static int btreeGetPage( BtShared *pBt, /* The btree */ Pgno pgno, /* Number of the page to fetch */ MemPage **ppPage, /* Return the page in this parameter */ int flags /* PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT or PAGER_GET_READONLY */ ){ int rc; DbPage *pDbPage; assert( flags==0 || flags==PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT || flags==PAGER_GET_READONLY ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pBt->pPager, pgno, (DbPage**)&pDbPage, flags); if( rc ) return rc; *ppPage = btreePageFromDbPage(pDbPage, pgno, pBt); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Retrieve a page from the pager cache. If the requested page is not ** already in the pager cache return NULL. Initialize the MemPage.pBt and ** MemPage.aData elements if needed. */ static MemPage *btreePageLookup(BtShared *pBt, Pgno pgno){ DbPage *pDbPage; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); pDbPage = sqlite3PagerLookup(pBt->pPager, pgno); if( pDbPage ){ return btreePageFromDbPage(pDbPage, pgno, pBt); } return 0; } /* ** Return the size of the database file in pages. If there is any kind of ** error, return ((unsigned int)-1). */ static Pgno btreePagecount(BtShared *pBt){ return pBt->nPage; } u32 sqlite3BtreeLastPage(Btree *p){ assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( ((p->pBt->nPage)&0x80000000)==0 ); return btreePagecount(p->pBt); } /* ** Get a page from the pager and initialize it. ** ** If pCur!=0 then the page is being fetched as part of a moveToChild() ** call. Do additional sanity checking on the page in this case. ** And if the fetch fails, this routine must decrement pCur->iPage. ** ** The page is fetched as read-write unless pCur is not NULL and is ** a read-only cursor. ** ** If an error occurs, then *ppPage is undefined. It ** may remain unchanged, or it may be set to an invalid value. */ static int getAndInitPage( BtShared *pBt, /* The database file */ Pgno pgno, /* Number of the page to get */ MemPage **ppPage, /* Write the page pointer here */ BtCursor *pCur, /* Cursor to receive the page, or NULL */ int bReadOnly /* True for a read-only page */ ){ int rc; DbPage *pDbPage; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( pCur==0 || ppPage==&pCur->pPage ); assert( pCur==0 || bReadOnly==pCur->curPagerFlags ); assert( pCur==0 || pCur->iPage>0 ); if( pgno>btreePagecount(pBt) ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto getAndInitPage_error; } rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pBt->pPager, pgno, (DbPage**)&pDbPage, bReadOnly); if( rc ){ goto getAndInitPage_error; } *ppPage = (MemPage*)sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pDbPage); if( (*ppPage)->isInit==0 ){ btreePageFromDbPage(pDbPage, pgno, pBt); rc = btreeInitPage(*ppPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(*ppPage); goto getAndInitPage_error; } } assert( (*ppPage)->pgno==pgno ); assert( (*ppPage)->aData==sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage) ); /* If obtaining a child page for a cursor, we must verify that the page is ** compatible with the root page. */ if( pCur && ((*ppPage)->nCell<1 || (*ppPage)->intKey!=pCur->curIntKey) ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(pgno); releasePage(*ppPage); goto getAndInitPage_error; } return SQLITE_OK; getAndInitPage_error: if( pCur ){ pCur->iPage--; pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage]; } testcase( pgno==0 ); assert( pgno!=0 || rc==SQLITE_CORRUPT ); return rc; } /* ** Release a MemPage. This should be called once for each prior ** call to btreeGetPage. ** ** Page1 is a special case and must be released using releasePageOne(). */ static void releasePageNotNull(MemPage *pPage){ assert( pPage->aData ); assert( pPage->pBt ); assert( pPage->pDbPage!=0 ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pPage->pDbPage) == (void*)pPage ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetData(pPage->pDbPage)==pPage->aData ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); sqlite3PagerUnrefNotNull(pPage->pDbPage); } static void releasePage(MemPage *pPage){ if( pPage ) releasePageNotNull(pPage); } static void releasePageOne(MemPage *pPage){ assert( pPage!=0 ); assert( pPage->aData ); assert( pPage->pBt ); assert( pPage->pDbPage!=0 ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pPage->pDbPage) == (void*)pPage ); assert( sqlite3PagerGetData(pPage->pDbPage)==pPage->aData ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); sqlite3PagerUnrefPageOne(pPage->pDbPage); } /* ** Get an unused page. ** ** This works just like btreeGetPage() with the addition: ** ** * If the page is already in use for some other purpose, immediately ** release it and return an SQLITE_CURRUPT error. ** * Make sure the isInit flag is clear */ static int btreeGetUnusedPage( BtShared *pBt, /* The btree */ Pgno pgno, /* Number of the page to fetch */ MemPage **ppPage, /* Return the page in this parameter */ int flags /* PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT or PAGER_GET_READONLY */ ){ int rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, pgno, ppPage, flags); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ if( sqlite3PagerPageRefcount((*ppPage)->pDbPage)>1 ){ releasePage(*ppPage); *ppPage = 0; return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } (*ppPage)->isInit = 0; }else{ *ppPage = 0; } return rc; } /* ** During a rollback, when the pager reloads information into the cache ** so that the cache is restored to its original state at the start of ** the transaction, for each page restored this routine is called. ** ** This routine needs to reset the extra data section at the end of the ** page to agree with the restored data. */ static void pageReinit(DbPage *pData){ MemPage *pPage; pPage = (MemPage *)sqlite3PagerGetExtra(pData); assert( sqlite3PagerPageRefcount(pData)>0 ); if( pPage->isInit ){ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); pPage->isInit = 0; if( sqlite3PagerPageRefcount(pData)>1 ){ /* pPage might not be a btree page; it might be an overflow page ** or ptrmap page or a free page. In those cases, the following ** call to btreeInitPage() will likely return SQLITE_CORRUPT. ** But no harm is done by this. And it is very important that ** btreeInitPage() be called on every btree page so we make ** the call for every page that comes in for re-initing. */ btreeInitPage(pPage); } } } /* ** Invoke the busy handler for a btree. */ static int btreeInvokeBusyHandler(void *pArg){ BtShared *pBt = (BtShared*)pArg; assert( pBt->db ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->db->mutex) ); return sqlite3InvokeBusyHandler(&pBt->db->busyHandler, sqlite3PagerFile(pBt->pPager)); } /* ** Open a database file. ** ** zFilename is the name of the database file. If zFilename is NULL ** then an ephemeral database is created. The ephemeral database might ** be exclusively in memory, or it might use a disk-based memory cache. ** Either way, the ephemeral database will be automatically deleted ** when sqlite3BtreeClose() is called. ** ** If zFilename is ":memory:" then an in-memory database is created ** that is automatically destroyed when it is closed. ** ** The "flags" parameter is a bitmask that might contain bits like ** BTREE_OMIT_JOURNAL and/or BTREE_MEMORY. ** ** If the database is already opened in the same database connection ** and we are in shared cache mode, then the open will fail with an ** SQLITE_CONSTRAINT error. We cannot allow two or more BtShared ** objects in the same database connection since doing so will lead ** to problems with locking. */ int sqlite3BtreeOpen( sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* VFS to use for this b-tree */ const char *zFilename, /* Name of the file containing the BTree database */ sqlite3 *db, /* Associated database handle */ Btree **ppBtree, /* Pointer to new Btree object written here */ int flags, /* Options */ int vfsFlags /* Flags passed through to sqlite3_vfs.xOpen() */ ){ BtShared *pBt = 0; /* Shared part of btree structure */ Btree *p; /* Handle to return */ sqlite3_mutex *mutexOpen = 0; /* Prevents a race condition. Ticket #3537 */ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code from this function */ u8 nReserve; /* Byte of unused space on each page */ unsigned char zDbHeader[100]; /* Database header content */ /* True if opening an ephemeral, temporary database */ const int isTempDb = zFilename==0 || zFilename[0]==0; /* Set the variable isMemdb to true for an in-memory database, or ** false for a file-based database. */ #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORYDB const int isMemdb = 0; #else const int isMemdb = (zFilename && strcmp(zFilename, ":memory:")==0) || (isTempDb && sqlite3TempInMemory(db)) || (vfsFlags & SQLITE_OPEN_MEMORY)!=0; #endif assert( db!=0 ); assert( pVfs!=0 ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) ); assert( (flags&0xff)==flags ); /* flags fit in 8 bits */ /* Only a BTREE_SINGLE database can be BTREE_UNORDERED */ assert( (flags & BTREE_UNORDERED)==0 || (flags & BTREE_SINGLE)!=0 ); /* A BTREE_SINGLE database is always a temporary and/or ephemeral */ assert( (flags & BTREE_SINGLE)==0 || isTempDb ); if( isMemdb ){ flags |= BTREE_MEMORY; } if( (vfsFlags & SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB)!=0 && (isMemdb || isTempDb) ){ vfsFlags = (vfsFlags & ~SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB) | SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB; } p = sqlite3MallocZero(sizeof(Btree)); if( !p ){ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } p->inTrans = TRANS_NONE; p->db = db; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE p->lock.pBtree = p; p->lock.iTable = 1; #endif #if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO) /* ** If this Btree is a candidate for shared cache, try to find an ** existing BtShared object that we can share with */ if( isTempDb==0 && (isMemdb==0 || (vfsFlags&SQLITE_OPEN_URI)!=0) ){ if( vfsFlags & SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE ){ int nFilename = sqlite3Strlen30(zFilename)+1; int nFullPathname = pVfs->mxPathname+1; char *zFullPathname = sqlite3Malloc(MAX(nFullPathname,nFilename)); MUTEX_LOGIC( sqlite3_mutex *mutexShared; ) p->sharable = 1; if( !zFullPathname ){ sqlite3_free(p); return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } if( isMemdb ){ memcpy(zFullPathname, zFilename, nFilename); }else{ rc = sqlite3OsFullPathname(pVfs, zFilename, nFullPathname, zFullPathname); if( rc ){ sqlite3_free(zFullPathname); sqlite3_free(p); return rc; } } #if SQLITE_THREADSAFE mutexOpen = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_OPEN); sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutexOpen); mutexShared = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER); sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutexShared); #endif for(pBt=GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList); pBt; pBt=pBt->pNext){ assert( pBt->nRef>0 ); if( 0==strcmp(zFullPathname, sqlite3PagerFilename(pBt->pPager, 0)) && sqlite3PagerVfs(pBt->pPager)==pVfs ){ int iDb; for(iDb=db->nDb-1; iDb>=0; iDb--){ Btree *pExisting = db->aDb[iDb].pBt; if( pExisting && pExisting->pBt==pBt ){ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutexShared); sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutexOpen); sqlite3_free(zFullPathname); sqlite3_free(p); return SQLITE_CONSTRAINT; } } p->pBt = pBt; pBt->nRef++; break; } } sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutexShared); sqlite3_free(zFullPathname); } #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG else{ /* In debug mode, we mark all persistent databases as sharable ** even when they are not. This exercises the locking code and ** gives more opportunity for asserts(sqlite3_mutex_held()) ** statements to find locking problems. */ p->sharable = 1; } #endif } #endif if( pBt==0 ){ /* ** The following asserts make sure that structures used by the btree are ** the right size. This is to guard against size changes that result ** when compiling on a different architecture. */ assert( sizeof(i64)==8 ); assert( sizeof(u64)==8 ); assert( sizeof(u32)==4 ); assert( sizeof(u16)==2 ); assert( sizeof(Pgno)==4 ); pBt = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*pBt) ); if( pBt==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; goto btree_open_out; } rc = sqlite3PagerOpen(pVfs, &pBt->pPager, zFilename, sizeof(MemPage), flags, vfsFlags, pageReinit); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ sqlite3PagerSetMmapLimit(pBt->pPager, db->szMmap); rc = sqlite3PagerReadFileheader(pBt->pPager,sizeof(zDbHeader),zDbHeader); } if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto btree_open_out; } pBt->openFlags = (u8)flags; pBt->db = db; sqlite3PagerSetBusyHandler(pBt->pPager, btreeInvokeBusyHandler, pBt); p->pBt = pBt; pBt->pCursor = 0; pBt->pPage1 = 0; if( sqlite3PagerIsreadonly(pBt->pPager) ) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_READ_ONLY; #if defined(SQLITE_SECURE_DELETE) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_SECURE_DELETE; #elif defined(SQLITE_FAST_SECURE_DELETE) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_OVERWRITE; #endif /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-51873-39618 The page size for a database file is ** determined by the 2-byte integer located at an offset of 16 bytes from ** the beginning of the database file. */ pBt->pageSize = (zDbHeader[16]<<8) | (zDbHeader[17]<<16); if( pBt->pageSize<512 || pBt->pageSize>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE || ((pBt->pageSize-1)&pBt->pageSize)!=0 ){ pBt->pageSize = 0; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* If the magic name ":memory:" will create an in-memory database, then ** leave the autoVacuum mode at 0 (do not auto-vacuum), even if ** SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM is true. On the other hand, if ** SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORYDB has been defined, then ":memory:" is just a ** regular file-name. In this case the auto-vacuum applies as per normal. */ if( zFilename && !isMemdb ){ pBt->autoVacuum = (SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM ? 1 : 0); pBt->incrVacuum = (SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM==2 ? 1 : 0); } #endif nReserve = 0; }else{ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-37497-42412 The size of the reserved region is ** determined by the one-byte unsigned integer found at an offset of 20 ** into the database file header. */ nReserve = zDbHeader[20]; pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM pBt->autoVacuum = (get4byte(&zDbHeader[36 + 4*4])?1:0); pBt->incrVacuum = (get4byte(&zDbHeader[36 + 7*4])?1:0); #endif } rc = sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(pBt->pPager, &pBt->pageSize, nReserve); if( rc ) goto btree_open_out; pBt->usableSize = pBt->pageSize - nReserve; assert( (pBt->pageSize & 7)==0 ); /* 8-byte alignment of pageSize */ #if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO) /* Add the new BtShared object to the linked list sharable BtShareds. */ pBt->nRef = 1; if( p->sharable ){ MUTEX_LOGIC( sqlite3_mutex *mutexShared; ) MUTEX_LOGIC( mutexShared = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER);) if( SQLITE_THREADSAFE && sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){ pBt->mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST); if( pBt->mutex==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; goto btree_open_out; } } sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutexShared); pBt->pNext = GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList); GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList) = pBt; sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutexShared); } #endif } #if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO) /* If the new Btree uses a sharable pBtShared, then link the new ** Btree into the list of all sharable Btrees for the same connection. ** The list is kept in ascending order by pBt address. */ if( p->sharable ){ int i; Btree *pSib; for(i=0; inDb; i++){ if( (pSib = db->aDb[i].pBt)!=0 && pSib->sharable ){ while( pSib->pPrev ){ pSib = pSib->pPrev; } if( (uptr)p->pBt<(uptr)pSib->pBt ){ p->pNext = pSib; p->pPrev = 0; pSib->pPrev = p; }else{ while( pSib->pNext && (uptr)pSib->pNext->pBt<(uptr)p->pBt ){ pSib = pSib->pNext; } p->pNext = pSib->pNext; p->pPrev = pSib; if( p->pNext ){ p->pNext->pPrev = p; } pSib->pNext = p; } break; } } } #endif *ppBtree = p; btree_open_out: if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ if( pBt && pBt->pPager ){ sqlite3PagerClose(pBt->pPager, 0); } sqlite3_free(pBt); sqlite3_free(p); *ppBtree = 0; }else{ sqlite3_file *pFile; /* If the B-Tree was successfully opened, set the pager-cache size to the ** default value. Except, when opening on an existing shared pager-cache, ** do not change the pager-cache size. */ if( sqlite3BtreeSchema(p, 0, 0)==0 ){ sqlite3PagerSetCachesize(p->pBt->pPager, SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE); } pFile = sqlite3PagerFile(pBt->pPager); if( pFile->pMethods ){ sqlite3OsFileControlHint(pFile, SQLITE_FCNTL_PDB, (void*)&pBt->db); } } if( mutexOpen ){ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mutexOpen) ); sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutexOpen); } assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || sqlite3BtreeConnectionCount(*ppBtree)>0 ); return rc; } /* ** Decrement the BtShared.nRef counter. When it reaches zero, ** remove the BtShared structure from the sharing list. Return ** true if the BtShared.nRef counter reaches zero and return ** false if it is still positive. */ static int removeFromSharingList(BtShared *pBt){ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE MUTEX_LOGIC( sqlite3_mutex *pMaster; ) BtShared *pList; int removed = 0; assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pBt->mutex) ); MUTEX_LOGIC( pMaster = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER); ) sqlite3_mutex_enter(pMaster); pBt->nRef--; if( pBt->nRef<=0 ){ if( GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList)==pBt ){ GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList) = pBt->pNext; }else{ pList = GLOBAL(BtShared*,sqlite3SharedCacheList); while( ALWAYS(pList) && pList->pNext!=pBt ){ pList=pList->pNext; } if( ALWAYS(pList) ){ pList->pNext = pBt->pNext; } } if( SQLITE_THREADSAFE ){ sqlite3_mutex_free(pBt->mutex); } removed = 1; } sqlite3_mutex_leave(pMaster); return removed; #else return 1; #endif } /* ** Make sure pBt->pTmpSpace points to an allocation of ** MX_CELL_SIZE(pBt) bytes with a 4-byte prefix for a left-child ** pointer. */ static void allocateTempSpace(BtShared *pBt){ if( !pBt->pTmpSpace ){ pBt->pTmpSpace = sqlite3PageMalloc( pBt->pageSize ); /* One of the uses of pBt->pTmpSpace is to format cells before ** inserting them into a leaf page (function fillInCell()). If ** a cell is less than 4 bytes in size, it is rounded up to 4 bytes ** by the various routines that manipulate binary cells. Which ** can mean that fillInCell() only initializes the first 2 or 3 ** bytes of pTmpSpace, but that the first 4 bytes are copied from ** it into a database page. This is not actually a problem, but it ** does cause a valgrind error when the 1 or 2 bytes of unitialized ** data is passed to system call write(). So to avoid this error, ** zero the first 4 bytes of temp space here. ** ** Also: Provide four bytes of initialized space before the ** beginning of pTmpSpace as an area available to prepend the ** left-child pointer to the beginning of a cell. */ if( pBt->pTmpSpace ){ memset(pBt->pTmpSpace, 0, 8); pBt->pTmpSpace += 4; } } } /* ** Free the pBt->pTmpSpace allocation */ static void freeTempSpace(BtShared *pBt){ if( pBt->pTmpSpace ){ pBt->pTmpSpace -= 4; sqlite3PageFree(pBt->pTmpSpace); pBt->pTmpSpace = 0; } } /* ** Close an open database and invalidate all cursors. */ int sqlite3BtreeClose(Btree *p){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; BtCursor *pCur; /* Close all cursors opened via this handle. */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); pCur = pBt->pCursor; while( pCur ){ BtCursor *pTmp = pCur; pCur = pCur->pNext; if( pTmp->pBtree==p ){ sqlite3BtreeCloseCursor(pTmp); } } /* Rollback any active transaction and free the handle structure. ** The call to sqlite3BtreeRollback() drops any table-locks held by ** this handle. */ sqlite3BtreeRollback(p, SQLITE_OK, 0); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); /* If there are still other outstanding references to the shared-btree ** structure, return now. The remainder of this procedure cleans ** up the shared-btree. */ assert( p->wantToLock==0 && p->locked==0 ); if( !p->sharable || removeFromSharingList(pBt) ){ /* The pBt is no longer on the sharing list, so we can access ** it without having to hold the mutex. ** ** Clean out and delete the BtShared object. */ assert( !pBt->pCursor ); sqlite3PagerClose(pBt->pPager, p->db); if( pBt->xFreeSchema && pBt->pSchema ){ pBt->xFreeSchema(pBt->pSchema); } sqlite3DbFree(0, pBt->pSchema); freeTempSpace(pBt); sqlite3_free(pBt); } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE assert( p->wantToLock==0 ); assert( p->locked==0 ); if( p->pPrev ) p->pPrev->pNext = p->pNext; if( p->pNext ) p->pNext->pPrev = p->pPrev; #endif sqlite3_free(p); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Change the "soft" limit on the number of pages in the cache. ** Unused and unmodified pages will be recycled when the number of ** pages in the cache exceeds this soft limit. But the size of the ** cache is allowed to grow larger than this limit if it contains ** dirty pages or pages still in active use. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetCacheSize(Btree *p, int mxPage){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); sqlite3PagerSetCachesize(pBt->pPager, mxPage); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Change the "spill" limit on the number of pages in the cache. ** If the number of pages exceeds this limit during a write transaction, ** the pager might attempt to "spill" pages to the journal early in ** order to free up memory. ** ** The value returned is the current spill size. If zero is passed ** as an argument, no changes are made to the spill size setting, so ** using mxPage of 0 is a way to query the current spill size. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetSpillSize(Btree *p, int mxPage){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; int res; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); res = sqlite3PagerSetSpillsize(pBt->pPager, mxPage); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return res; } #if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 /* ** Change the limit on the amount of the database file that may be ** memory mapped. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetMmapLimit(Btree *p, sqlite3_int64 szMmap){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); sqlite3PagerSetMmapLimit(pBt->pPager, szMmap); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return SQLITE_OK; } #endif /* SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 */ /* ** Change the way data is synced to disk in order to increase or decrease ** how well the database resists damage due to OS crashes and power ** failures. Level 1 is the same as asynchronous (no syncs() occur and ** there is a high probability of damage) Level 2 is the default. There ** is a very low but non-zero probability of damage. Level 3 reduces the ** probability of damage to near zero but with a write performance reduction. */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_PAGER_PRAGMAS int sqlite3BtreeSetPagerFlags( Btree *p, /* The btree to set the safety level on */ unsigned pgFlags /* Various PAGER_* flags */ ){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); sqlite3PagerSetFlags(pBt->pPager, pgFlags); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return SQLITE_OK; } #endif /* ** Change the default pages size and the number of reserved bytes per page. ** Or, if the page size has already been fixed, return SQLITE_READONLY ** without changing anything. ** ** The page size must be a power of 2 between 512 and 65536. If the page ** size supplied does not meet this constraint then the page size is not ** changed. ** ** Page sizes are constrained to be a power of two so that the region ** of the database file used for locking (beginning at PENDING_BYTE, ** the first byte past the 1GB boundary, 0x40000000) needs to occur ** at the beginning of a page. ** ** If parameter nReserve is less than zero, then the number of reserved ** bytes per page is left unchanged. ** ** If the iFix!=0 then the BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED flag is set so that the page size ** and autovacuum mode can no longer be changed. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetPageSize(Btree *p, int pageSize, int nReserve, int iFix){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( nReserve>=-1 && nReserve<=255 ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); #if SQLITE_HAS_CODEC if( nReserve>pBt->optimalReserve ) pBt->optimalReserve = (u8)nReserve; #endif if( pBt->btsFlags & BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED ){ sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return SQLITE_READONLY; } if( nReserve<0 ){ nReserve = pBt->pageSize - pBt->usableSize; } assert( nReserve>=0 && nReserve<=255 ); if( pageSize>=512 && pageSize<=SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE && ((pageSize-1)&pageSize)==0 ){ assert( (pageSize & 7)==0 ); assert( !pBt->pCursor ); pBt->pageSize = (u32)pageSize; freeTempSpace(pBt); } rc = sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(pBt->pPager, &pBt->pageSize, nReserve); pBt->usableSize = pBt->pageSize - (u16)nReserve; if( iFix ) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED; sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** Return the currently defined page size */ int sqlite3BtreeGetPageSize(Btree *p){ return p->pBt->pageSize; } /* ** This function is similar to sqlite3BtreeGetReserve(), except that it ** may only be called if it is guaranteed that the b-tree mutex is already ** held. ** ** This is useful in one special case in the backup API code where it is ** known that the shared b-tree mutex is held, but the mutex on the ** database handle that owns *p is not. In this case if sqlite3BtreeEnter() ** were to be called, it might collide with some other operation on the ** database handle that owns *p, causing undefined behavior. */ int sqlite3BtreeGetReserveNoMutex(Btree *p){ int n; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->pBt->mutex) ); n = p->pBt->pageSize - p->pBt->usableSize; return n; } /* ** Return the number of bytes of space at the end of every page that ** are intentually left unused. This is the "reserved" space that is ** sometimes used by extensions. ** ** If SQLITE_HAS_MUTEX is defined then the number returned is the ** greater of the current reserved space and the maximum requested ** reserve space. */ int sqlite3BtreeGetOptimalReserve(Btree *p){ int n; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); n = sqlite3BtreeGetReserveNoMutex(p); #ifdef SQLITE_HAS_CODEC if( npBt->optimalReserve ) n = p->pBt->optimalReserve; #endif sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return n; } /* ** Set the maximum page count for a database if mxPage is positive. ** No changes are made if mxPage is 0 or negative. ** Regardless of the value of mxPage, return the maximum page count. */ int sqlite3BtreeMaxPageCount(Btree *p, int mxPage){ int n; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); n = sqlite3PagerMaxPageCount(p->pBt->pPager, mxPage); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return n; } /* ** Change the values for the BTS_SECURE_DELETE and BTS_OVERWRITE flags: ** ** newFlag==0 Both BTS_SECURE_DELETE and BTS_OVERWRITE are cleared ** newFlag==1 BTS_SECURE_DELETE set and BTS_OVERWRITE is cleared ** newFlag==2 BTS_SECURE_DELETE cleared and BTS_OVERWRITE is set ** newFlag==(-1) No changes ** ** This routine acts as a query if newFlag is less than zero ** ** With BTS_OVERWRITE set, deleted content is overwritten by zeros, but ** freelist leaf pages are not written back to the database. Thus in-page ** deleted content is cleared, but freelist deleted content is not. ** ** With BTS_SECURE_DELETE, operation is like BTS_OVERWRITE with the addition ** that freelist leaf pages are written back into the database, increasing ** the amount of disk I/O. */ int sqlite3BtreeSecureDelete(Btree *p, int newFlag){ int b; if( p==0 ) return 0; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( BTS_OVERWRITE==BTS_SECURE_DELETE*2 ); assert( BTS_FAST_SECURE==(BTS_OVERWRITE|BTS_SECURE_DELETE) ); if( newFlag>=0 ){ p->pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_FAST_SECURE; p->pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_SECURE_DELETE*newFlag; } b = (p->pBt->btsFlags & BTS_FAST_SECURE)/BTS_SECURE_DELETE; sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return b; } /* ** Change the 'auto-vacuum' property of the database. If the 'autoVacuum' ** parameter is non-zero, then auto-vacuum mode is enabled. If zero, it ** is disabled. The default value for the auto-vacuum property is ** determined by the SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM macro. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetAutoVacuum(Btree *p, int autoVacuum){ #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM return SQLITE_READONLY; #else BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; int rc = SQLITE_OK; u8 av = (u8)autoVacuum; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); if( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED)!=0 && (av ?1:0)!=pBt->autoVacuum ){ rc = SQLITE_READONLY; }else{ pBt->autoVacuum = av ?1:0; pBt->incrVacuum = av==2 ?1:0; } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; #endif } /* ** Return the value of the 'auto-vacuum' property. If auto-vacuum is ** enabled 1 is returned. Otherwise 0. */ int sqlite3BtreeGetAutoVacuum(Btree *p){ #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM return BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_NONE; #else int rc; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = ( (!p->pBt->autoVacuum)?BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_NONE: (!p->pBt->incrVacuum)?BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_FULL: BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_INCR ); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; #endif } /* ** If the user has not set the safety-level for this database connection ** using "PRAGMA synchronous", and if the safety-level is not already ** set to the value passed to this function as the second parameter, ** set it so. */ #if SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS!=SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS \ && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) static void setDefaultSyncFlag(BtShared *pBt, u8 safety_level){ sqlite3 *db; Db *pDb; if( (db=pBt->db)!=0 && (pDb=db->aDb)!=0 ){ while( pDb->pBt==0 || pDb->pBt->pBt!=pBt ){ pDb++; } if( pDb->bSyncSet==0 && pDb->safety_level!=safety_level && pDb!=&db->aDb[1] ){ pDb->safety_level = safety_level; sqlite3PagerSetFlags(pBt->pPager, pDb->safety_level | (db->flags & PAGER_FLAGS_MASK)); } } } #else # define setDefaultSyncFlag(pBt,safety_level) #endif /* Forward declaration */ static int newDatabase(BtShared*); /* ** Get a reference to pPage1 of the database file. This will ** also acquire a readlock on that file. ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned on success. If the file is not a ** well-formed database file, then SQLITE_CORRUPT is returned. ** SQLITE_BUSY is returned if the database is locked. SQLITE_NOMEM ** is returned if we run out of memory. */ static int lockBtree(BtShared *pBt){ int rc; /* Result code from subfunctions */ MemPage *pPage1; /* Page 1 of the database file */ int nPage; /* Number of pages in the database */ int nPageFile = 0; /* Number of pages in the database file */ int nPageHeader; /* Number of pages in the database according to hdr */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( pBt->pPage1==0 ); rc = sqlite3PagerSharedLock(pBt->pPager); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc; rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, 1, &pPage1, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc; /* Do some checking to help insure the file we opened really is ** a valid database file. */ nPage = nPageHeader = get4byte(28+(u8*)pPage1->aData); sqlite3PagerPagecount(pBt->pPager, &nPageFile); if( nPage==0 || memcmp(24+(u8*)pPage1->aData, 92+(u8*)pPage1->aData,4)!=0 ){ nPage = nPageFile; } if( (pBt->db->flags & SQLITE_ResetDatabase)!=0 ){ nPage = 0; } if( nPage>0 ){ u32 pageSize; u32 usableSize; u8 *page1 = pPage1->aData; rc = SQLITE_NOTADB; /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-43737-39999 Every valid SQLite database file begins ** with the following 16 bytes (in hex): 53 51 4c 69 74 65 20 66 6f 72 6d ** 61 74 20 33 00. */ if( memcmp(page1, zMagicHeader, 16)!=0 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL if( page1[18]>1 ){ pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_READ_ONLY; } if( page1[19]>1 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } #else if( page1[18]>2 ){ pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_READ_ONLY; } if( page1[19]>2 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } /* If the write version is set to 2, this database should be accessed ** in WAL mode. If the log is not already open, open it now. Then ** return SQLITE_OK and return without populating BtShared.pPage1. ** The caller detects this and calls this function again. This is ** required as the version of page 1 currently in the page1 buffer ** may not be the latest version - there may be a newer one in the log ** file. */ if( page1[19]==2 && (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_NO_WAL)==0 ){ int isOpen = 0; rc = sqlite3PagerOpenWal(pBt->pPager, &isOpen); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto page1_init_failed; }else{ setDefaultSyncFlag(pBt, SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS+1); if( isOpen==0 ){ releasePageOne(pPage1); return SQLITE_OK; } } rc = SQLITE_NOTADB; }else{ setDefaultSyncFlag(pBt, SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS+1); } #endif /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-15465-20813 The maximum and minimum embedded payload ** fractions and the leaf payload fraction values must be 64, 32, and 32. ** ** The original design allowed these amounts to vary, but as of ** version 3.6.0, we require them to be fixed. */ if( memcmp(&page1[21], "\100\040\040",3)!=0 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-51873-39618 The page size for a database file is ** determined by the 2-byte integer located at an offset of 16 bytes from ** the beginning of the database file. */ pageSize = (page1[16]<<8) | (page1[17]<<16); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-25008-21688 The size of a page is a power of two ** between 512 and 65536 inclusive. */ if( ((pageSize-1)&pageSize)!=0 || pageSize>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE || pageSize<=256 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } assert( (pageSize & 7)==0 ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-59310-51205 The "reserved space" size in the 1-byte ** integer at offset 20 is the number of bytes of space at the end of ** each page to reserve for extensions. ** ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-37497-42412 The size of the reserved region is ** determined by the one-byte unsigned integer found at an offset of 20 ** into the database file header. */ usableSize = pageSize - page1[20]; if( (u32)pageSize!=pBt->pageSize ){ /* After reading the first page of the database assuming a page size ** of BtShared.pageSize, we have discovered that the page-size is ** actually pageSize. Unlock the database, leave pBt->pPage1 at ** zero and return SQLITE_OK. The caller will call this function ** again with the correct page-size. */ releasePageOne(pPage1); pBt->usableSize = usableSize; pBt->pageSize = pageSize; freeTempSpace(pBt); rc = sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(pBt->pPager, &pBt->pageSize, pageSize-usableSize); return rc; } if( sqlite3WritableSchema(pBt->db)==0 && nPage>nPageFile ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto page1_init_failed; } /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-28312-64704 However, the usable size is not allowed to ** be less than 480. In other words, if the page size is 512, then the ** reserved space size cannot exceed 32. */ if( usableSize<480 ){ goto page1_init_failed; } pBt->pageSize = pageSize; pBt->usableSize = usableSize; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM pBt->autoVacuum = (get4byte(&page1[36 + 4*4])?1:0); pBt->incrVacuum = (get4byte(&page1[36 + 7*4])?1:0); #endif } /* maxLocal is the maximum amount of payload to store locally for ** a cell. Make sure it is small enough so that at least minFanout ** cells can will fit on one page. We assume a 10-byte page header. ** Besides the payload, the cell must store: ** 2-byte pointer to the cell ** 4-byte child pointer ** 9-byte nKey value ** 4-byte nData value ** 4-byte overflow page pointer ** So a cell consists of a 2-byte pointer, a header which is as much as ** 17 bytes long, 0 to N bytes of payload, and an optional 4 byte overflow ** page pointer. */ pBt->maxLocal = (u16)((pBt->usableSize-12)*64/255 - 23); pBt->minLocal = (u16)((pBt->usableSize-12)*32/255 - 23); pBt->maxLeaf = (u16)(pBt->usableSize - 35); pBt->minLeaf = (u16)((pBt->usableSize-12)*32/255 - 23); if( pBt->maxLocal>127 ){ pBt->max1bytePayload = 127; }else{ pBt->max1bytePayload = (u8)pBt->maxLocal; } assert( pBt->maxLeaf + 23 <= MX_CELL_SIZE(pBt) ); pBt->pPage1 = pPage1; pBt->nPage = nPage; return SQLITE_OK; page1_init_failed: releasePageOne(pPage1); pBt->pPage1 = 0; return rc; } #ifndef NDEBUG /* ** Return the number of cursors open on pBt. This is for use ** in assert() expressions, so it is only compiled if NDEBUG is not ** defined. ** ** Only write cursors are counted if wrOnly is true. If wrOnly is ** false then all cursors are counted. ** ** For the purposes of this routine, a cursor is any cursor that ** is capable of reading or writing to the database. Cursors that ** have been tripped into the CURSOR_FAULT state are not counted. */ static int countValidCursors(BtShared *pBt, int wrOnly){ BtCursor *pCur; int r = 0; for(pCur=pBt->pCursor; pCur; pCur=pCur->pNext){ if( (wrOnly==0 || (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_WriteFlag)!=0) && pCur->eState!=CURSOR_FAULT ) r++; } return r; } #endif /* ** If there are no outstanding cursors and we are not in the middle ** of a transaction but there is a read lock on the database, then ** this routine unrefs the first page of the database file which ** has the effect of releasing the read lock. ** ** If there is a transaction in progress, this routine is a no-op. */ static void unlockBtreeIfUnused(BtShared *pBt){ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( countValidCursors(pBt,0)==0 || pBt->inTransaction>TRANS_NONE ); if( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_NONE && pBt->pPage1!=0 ){ MemPage *pPage1 = pBt->pPage1; assert( pPage1->aData ); assert( sqlite3PagerRefcount(pBt->pPager)==1 ); pBt->pPage1 = 0; releasePageOne(pPage1); } } /* ** If pBt points to an empty file then convert that empty file ** into a new empty database by initializing the first page of ** the database. */ static int newDatabase(BtShared *pBt){ MemPage *pP1; unsigned char *data; int rc; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); if( pBt->nPage>0 ){ return SQLITE_OK; } pP1 = pBt->pPage1; assert( pP1!=0 ); data = pP1->aData; rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pP1->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; memcpy(data, zMagicHeader, sizeof(zMagicHeader)); assert( sizeof(zMagicHeader)==16 ); data[16] = (u8)((pBt->pageSize>>8)&0xff); data[17] = (u8)((pBt->pageSize>>16)&0xff); data[18] = 1; data[19] = 1; assert( pBt->usableSize<=pBt->pageSize && pBt->usableSize+255>=pBt->pageSize); data[20] = (u8)(pBt->pageSize - pBt->usableSize); data[21] = 64; data[22] = 32; data[23] = 32; memset(&data[24], 0, 100-24); zeroPage(pP1, PTF_INTKEY|PTF_LEAF|PTF_LEAFDATA ); pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_PAGESIZE_FIXED; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM assert( pBt->autoVacuum==1 || pBt->autoVacuum==0 ); assert( pBt->incrVacuum==1 || pBt->incrVacuum==0 ); put4byte(&data[36 + 4*4], pBt->autoVacuum); put4byte(&data[36 + 7*4], pBt->incrVacuum); #endif pBt->nPage = 1; data[31] = 1; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Initialize the first page of the database file (creating a database ** consisting of a single page and no schema objects). Return SQLITE_OK ** if successful, or an SQLite error code otherwise. */ int sqlite3BtreeNewDb(Btree *p){ int rc; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); p->pBt->nPage = 0; rc = newDatabase(p->pBt); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** Attempt to start a new transaction. A write-transaction ** is started if the second argument is nonzero, otherwise a read- ** transaction. If the second argument is 2 or more and exclusive ** transaction is started, meaning that no other process is allowed ** to access the database. A preexisting transaction may not be ** upgraded to exclusive by calling this routine a second time - the ** exclusivity flag only works for a new transaction. ** ** A write-transaction must be started before attempting any ** changes to the database. None of the following routines ** will work unless a transaction is started first: ** ** sqlite3BtreeCreateTable() ** sqlite3BtreeCreateIndex() ** sqlite3BtreeClearTable() ** sqlite3BtreeDropTable() ** sqlite3BtreeInsert() ** sqlite3BtreeDelete() ** sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta() ** ** If an initial attempt to acquire the lock fails because of lock contention ** and the database was previously unlocked, then invoke the busy handler ** if there is one. But if there was previously a read-lock, do not ** invoke the busy handler - just return SQLITE_BUSY. SQLITE_BUSY is ** returned when there is already a read-lock in order to avoid a deadlock. ** ** Suppose there are two processes A and B. A has a read lock and B has ** a reserved lock. B tries to promote to exclusive but is blocked because ** of A's read lock. A tries to promote to reserved but is blocked by B. ** One or the other of the two processes must give way or there can be ** no progress. By returning SQLITE_BUSY and not invoking the busy callback ** when A already has a read lock, we encourage A to give up and let B ** proceed. */ int sqlite3BtreeBeginTrans(Btree *p, int wrflag, int *pSchemaVersion){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; int rc = SQLITE_OK; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); btreeIntegrity(p); /* If the btree is already in a write-transaction, or it ** is already in a read-transaction and a read-transaction ** is requested, this is a no-op. */ if( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE || (p->inTrans==TRANS_READ && !wrflag) ){ goto trans_begun; } assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE || IfNotOmitAV(pBt->bDoTruncate)==0 ); if( (p->db->flags & SQLITE_ResetDatabase) && sqlite3PagerIsreadonly(pBt->pPager)==0 ){ pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_READ_ONLY; } /* Write transactions are not possible on a read-only database */ if( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)!=0 && wrflag ){ rc = SQLITE_READONLY; goto trans_begun; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE { sqlite3 *pBlock = 0; /* If another database handle has already opened a write transaction ** on this shared-btree structure and a second write transaction is ** requested, return SQLITE_LOCKED. */ if( (wrflag && pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE) || (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_PENDING)!=0 ){ pBlock = pBt->pWriter->db; }else if( wrflag>1 ){ BtLock *pIter; for(pIter=pBt->pLock; pIter; pIter=pIter->pNext){ if( pIter->pBtree!=p ){ pBlock = pIter->pBtree->db; break; } } } if( pBlock ){ sqlite3ConnectionBlocked(p->db, pBlock); rc = SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE; goto trans_begun; } } #endif /* Any read-only or read-write transaction implies a read-lock on ** page 1. So if some other shared-cache client already has a write-lock ** on page 1, the transaction cannot be opened. */ rc = querySharedCacheTableLock(p, MASTER_ROOT, READ_LOCK); if( SQLITE_OK!=rc ) goto trans_begun; pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_INITIALLY_EMPTY; if( pBt->nPage==0 ) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_INITIALLY_EMPTY; do { /* Call lockBtree() until either pBt->pPage1 is populated or ** lockBtree() returns something other than SQLITE_OK. lockBtree() ** may return SQLITE_OK but leave pBt->pPage1 set to 0 if after ** reading page 1 it discovers that the page-size of the database ** file is not pBt->pageSize. In this case lockBtree() will update ** pBt->pageSize to the page-size of the file on disk. */ while( pBt->pPage1==0 && SQLITE_OK==(rc = lockBtree(pBt)) ); if( rc==SQLITE_OK && wrflag ){ if( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)!=0 ){ rc = SQLITE_READONLY; }else{ rc = sqlite3PagerBegin(pBt->pPager,wrflag>1,sqlite3TempInMemory(p->db)); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = newDatabase(pBt); }else if( rc==SQLITE_BUSY_SNAPSHOT && pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_NONE ){ /* if there was no transaction opened when this function was ** called and SQLITE_BUSY_SNAPSHOT is returned, change the error ** code to SQLITE_BUSY. */ rc = SQLITE_BUSY; } } } if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt); } }while( (rc&0xFF)==SQLITE_BUSY && pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_NONE && btreeInvokeBusyHandler(pBt) ); sqlite3PagerResetLockTimeout(pBt->pPager); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ if( p->inTrans==TRANS_NONE ){ pBt->nTransaction++; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE if( p->sharable ){ assert( p->lock.pBtree==p && p->lock.iTable==1 ); p->lock.eLock = READ_LOCK; p->lock.pNext = pBt->pLock; pBt->pLock = &p->lock; } #endif } p->inTrans = (wrflag?TRANS_WRITE:TRANS_READ); if( p->inTrans>pBt->inTransaction ){ pBt->inTransaction = p->inTrans; } if( wrflag ){ MemPage *pPage1 = pBt->pPage1; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE assert( !pBt->pWriter ); pBt->pWriter = p; pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_EXCLUSIVE; if( wrflag>1 ) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_EXCLUSIVE; #endif /* If the db-size header field is incorrect (as it may be if an old ** client has been writing the database file), update it now. Doing ** this sooner rather than later means the database size can safely ** re-read the database size from page 1 if a savepoint or transaction ** rollback occurs within the transaction. */ if( pBt->nPage!=get4byte(&pPage1->aData[28]) ){ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ put4byte(&pPage1->aData[28], pBt->nPage); } } } } trans_begun: if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ if( pSchemaVersion ){ *pSchemaVersion = get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[40]); } if( wrflag ){ /* This call makes sure that the pager has the correct number of ** open savepoints. If the second parameter is greater than 0 and ** the sub-journal is not already open, then it will be opened here. */ rc = sqlite3PagerOpenSavepoint(pBt->pPager, p->db->nSavepoint); } } btreeIntegrity(p); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* ** Set the pointer-map entries for all children of page pPage. Also, if ** pPage contains cells that point to overflow pages, set the pointer ** map entries for the overflow pages as well. */ static int setChildPtrmaps(MemPage *pPage){ int i; /* Counter variable */ int nCell; /* Number of cells in page pPage */ int rc; /* Return code */ BtShared *pBt = pPage->pBt; Pgno pgno = pPage->pgno; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); rc = pPage->isInit ? SQLITE_OK : btreeInitPage(pPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc; nCell = pPage->nCell; for(i=0; ileaf ){ Pgno childPgno = get4byte(pCell); ptrmapPut(pBt, childPgno, PTRMAP_BTREE, pgno, &rc); } } if( !pPage->leaf ){ Pgno childPgno = get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8]); ptrmapPut(pBt, childPgno, PTRMAP_BTREE, pgno, &rc); } return rc; } /* ** Somewhere on pPage is a pointer to page iFrom. Modify this pointer so ** that it points to iTo. Parameter eType describes the type of pointer to ** be modified, as follows: ** ** PTRMAP_BTREE: pPage is a btree-page. The pointer points at a child ** page of pPage. ** ** PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1: pPage is a btree-page. The pointer points at an overflow ** page pointed to by one of the cells on pPage. ** ** PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2: pPage is an overflow-page. The pointer points at the next ** overflow page in the list. */ static int modifyPagePointer(MemPage *pPage, Pgno iFrom, Pgno iTo, u8 eType){ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); if( eType==PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2 ){ /* The pointer is always the first 4 bytes of the page in this case. */ if( get4byte(pPage->aData)!=iFrom ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } put4byte(pPage->aData, iTo); }else{ int i; int nCell; int rc; rc = pPage->isInit ? SQLITE_OK : btreeInitPage(pPage); if( rc ) return rc; nCell = pPage->nCell; for(i=0; ixParseCell(pPage, pCell, &info); if( info.nLocal pPage->aData+pPage->pBt->usableSize ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } if( iFrom==get4byte(pCell+info.nSize-4) ){ put4byte(pCell+info.nSize-4, iTo); break; } } }else{ if( get4byte(pCell)==iFrom ){ put4byte(pCell, iTo); break; } } } if( i==nCell ){ if( eType!=PTRMAP_BTREE || get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8])!=iFrom ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } put4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8], iTo); } } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Move the open database page pDbPage to location iFreePage in the ** database. The pDbPage reference remains valid. ** ** The isCommit flag indicates that there is no need to remember that ** the journal needs to be sync()ed before database page pDbPage->pgno ** can be written to. The caller has already promised not to write to that ** page. */ static int relocatePage( BtShared *pBt, /* Btree */ MemPage *pDbPage, /* Open page to move */ u8 eType, /* Pointer map 'type' entry for pDbPage */ Pgno iPtrPage, /* Pointer map 'page-no' entry for pDbPage */ Pgno iFreePage, /* The location to move pDbPage to */ int isCommit /* isCommit flag passed to sqlite3PagerMovepage */ ){ MemPage *pPtrPage; /* The page that contains a pointer to pDbPage */ Pgno iDbPage = pDbPage->pgno; Pager *pPager = pBt->pPager; int rc; assert( eType==PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2 || eType==PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1 || eType==PTRMAP_BTREE || eType==PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( pDbPage->pBt==pBt ); if( iDbPage<3 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; /* Move page iDbPage from its current location to page number iFreePage */ TRACE(("AUTOVACUUM: Moving %d to free page %d (ptr page %d type %d)\n", iDbPage, iFreePage, iPtrPage, eType)); rc = sqlite3PagerMovepage(pPager, pDbPage->pDbPage, iFreePage, isCommit); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } pDbPage->pgno = iFreePage; /* If pDbPage was a btree-page, then it may have child pages and/or cells ** that point to overflow pages. The pointer map entries for all these ** pages need to be changed. ** ** If pDbPage is an overflow page, then the first 4 bytes may store a ** pointer to a subsequent overflow page. If this is the case, then ** the pointer map needs to be updated for the subsequent overflow page. */ if( eType==PTRMAP_BTREE || eType==PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE ){ rc = setChildPtrmaps(pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } }else{ Pgno nextOvfl = get4byte(pDbPage->aData); if( nextOvfl!=0 ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, nextOvfl, PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2, iFreePage, &rc); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } } } /* Fix the database pointer on page iPtrPage that pointed at iDbPage so ** that it points at iFreePage. Also fix the pointer map entry for ** iPtrPage. */ if( eType!=PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE ){ rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, iPtrPage, &pPtrPage, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPtrPage->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(pPtrPage); return rc; } rc = modifyPagePointer(pPtrPage, iDbPage, iFreePage, eType); releasePage(pPtrPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, iFreePage, eType, iPtrPage, &rc); } } return rc; } /* Forward declaration required by incrVacuumStep(). */ static int allocateBtreePage(BtShared *, MemPage **, Pgno *, Pgno, u8); /* ** Perform a single step of an incremental-vacuum. If successful, return ** SQLITE_OK. If there is no work to do (and therefore no point in ** calling this function again), return SQLITE_DONE. Or, if an error ** occurs, return some other error code. ** ** More specifically, this function attempts to re-organize the database so ** that the last page of the file currently in use is no longer in use. ** ** Parameter nFin is the number of pages that this database would contain ** were this function called until it returns SQLITE_DONE. ** ** If the bCommit parameter is non-zero, this function assumes that the ** caller will keep calling incrVacuumStep() until it returns SQLITE_DONE ** or an error. bCommit is passed true for an auto-vacuum-on-commit ** operation, or false for an incremental vacuum. */ static int incrVacuumStep(BtShared *pBt, Pgno nFin, Pgno iLastPg, int bCommit){ Pgno nFreeList; /* Number of pages still on the free-list */ int rc; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( iLastPg>nFin ); if( !PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, iLastPg) && iLastPg!=PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ u8 eType; Pgno iPtrPage; nFreeList = get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36]); if( nFreeList==0 ){ return SQLITE_DONE; } rc = ptrmapGet(pBt, iLastPg, &eType, &iPtrPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } if( eType==PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } if( eType==PTRMAP_FREEPAGE ){ if( bCommit==0 ){ /* Remove the page from the files free-list. This is not required ** if bCommit is non-zero. In that case, the free-list will be ** truncated to zero after this function returns, so it doesn't ** matter if it still contains some garbage entries. */ Pgno iFreePg; MemPage *pFreePg; rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pFreePg, &iFreePg, iLastPg, BTALLOC_EXACT); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } assert( iFreePg==iLastPg ); releasePage(pFreePg); } } else { Pgno iFreePg; /* Index of free page to move pLastPg to */ MemPage *pLastPg; u8 eMode = BTALLOC_ANY; /* Mode parameter for allocateBtreePage() */ Pgno iNear = 0; /* nearby parameter for allocateBtreePage() */ rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, iLastPg, &pLastPg, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } /* If bCommit is zero, this loop runs exactly once and page pLastPg ** is swapped with the first free page pulled off the free list. ** ** On the other hand, if bCommit is greater than zero, then keep ** looping until a free-page located within the first nFin pages ** of the file is found. */ if( bCommit==0 ){ eMode = BTALLOC_LE; iNear = nFin; } do { MemPage *pFreePg; rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pFreePg, &iFreePg, iNear, eMode); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(pLastPg); return rc; } releasePage(pFreePg); }while( bCommit && iFreePg>nFin ); assert( iFreePgbDoTruncate = 1; pBt->nPage = iLastPg; } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** The database opened by the first argument is an auto-vacuum database ** nOrig pages in size containing nFree free pages. Return the expected ** size of the database in pages following an auto-vacuum operation. */ static Pgno finalDbSize(BtShared *pBt, Pgno nOrig, Pgno nFree){ int nEntry; /* Number of entries on one ptrmap page */ Pgno nPtrmap; /* Number of PtrMap pages to be freed */ Pgno nFin; /* Return value */ nEntry = pBt->usableSize/5; nPtrmap = (nFree-nOrig+PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, nOrig)+nEntry)/nEntry; nFin = nOrig - nFree - nPtrmap; if( nOrig>PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) && nFinpBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE && p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); if( !pBt->autoVacuum ){ rc = SQLITE_DONE; }else{ Pgno nOrig = btreePagecount(pBt); Pgno nFree = get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36]); Pgno nFin = finalDbSize(pBt, nOrig, nFree); if( nOrig0 ){ rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, 0, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ invalidateAllOverflowCache(pBt); rc = incrVacuumStep(pBt, nFin, nOrig, 0); } if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage); put4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[28], pBt->nPage); } }else{ rc = SQLITE_DONE; } } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** This routine is called prior to sqlite3PagerCommit when a transaction ** is committed for an auto-vacuum database. ** ** If SQLITE_OK is returned, then *pnTrunc is set to the number of pages ** the database file should be truncated to during the commit process. ** i.e. the database has been reorganized so that only the first *pnTrunc ** pages are in use. */ static int autoVacuumCommit(BtShared *pBt){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; Pager *pPager = pBt->pPager; VVA_ONLY( int nRef = sqlite3PagerRefcount(pPager); ) assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); invalidateAllOverflowCache(pBt); assert(pBt->autoVacuum); if( !pBt->incrVacuum ){ Pgno nFin; /* Number of pages in database after autovacuuming */ Pgno nFree; /* Number of pages on the freelist initially */ Pgno iFree; /* The next page to be freed */ Pgno nOrig; /* Database size before freeing */ nOrig = btreePagecount(pBt); if( PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, nOrig) || nOrig==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ /* It is not possible to create a database for which the final page ** is either a pointer-map page or the pending-byte page. If one ** is encountered, this indicates corruption. */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } nFree = get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36]); nFin = finalDbSize(pBt, nOrig, nFree); if( nFin>nOrig ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; if( nFinnFin && rc==SQLITE_OK; iFree--){ rc = incrVacuumStep(pBt, nFin, iFree, 1); } if( (rc==SQLITE_DONE || rc==SQLITE_OK) && nFree>0 ){ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage); put4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[32], 0); put4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36], 0); put4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[28], nFin); pBt->bDoTruncate = 1; pBt->nPage = nFin; } if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ sqlite3PagerRollback(pPager); } } assert( nRef>=sqlite3PagerRefcount(pPager) ); return rc; } #else /* ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM */ # define setChildPtrmaps(x) SQLITE_OK #endif /* ** This routine does the first phase of a two-phase commit. This routine ** causes a rollback journal to be created (if it does not already exist) ** and populated with enough information so that if a power loss occurs ** the database can be restored to its original state by playing back ** the journal. Then the contents of the journal are flushed out to ** the disk. After the journal is safely on oxide, the changes to the ** database are written into the database file and flushed to oxide. ** At the end of this call, the rollback journal still exists on the ** disk and we are still holding all locks, so the transaction has not ** committed. See sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseTwo() for the second phase of the ** commit process. ** ** This call is a no-op if no write-transaction is currently active on pBt. ** ** Otherwise, sync the database file for the btree pBt. zMaster points to ** the name of a master journal file that should be written into the ** individual journal file, or is NULL, indicating no master journal file ** (single database transaction). ** ** When this is called, the master journal should already have been ** created, populated with this journal pointer and synced to disk. ** ** Once this is routine has returned, the only thing required to commit ** the write-transaction for this database file is to delete the journal. */ int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne(Btree *p, const char *zMaster){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; if( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ rc = autoVacuumCommit(pBt); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } } if( pBt->bDoTruncate ){ sqlite3PagerTruncateImage(pBt->pPager, pBt->nPage); } #endif rc = sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseOne(pBt->pPager, zMaster, 0); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } return rc; } /* ** This function is called from both BtreeCommitPhaseTwo() and BtreeRollback() ** at the conclusion of a transaction. */ static void btreeEndTransaction(Btree *p){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3 *db = p->db; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM pBt->bDoTruncate = 0; #endif if( p->inTrans>TRANS_NONE && db->nVdbeRead>1 ){ /* If there are other active statements that belong to this database ** handle, downgrade to a read-only transaction. The other statements ** may still be reading from the database. */ downgradeAllSharedCacheTableLocks(p); p->inTrans = TRANS_READ; }else{ /* If the handle had any kind of transaction open, decrement the ** transaction count of the shared btree. If the transaction count ** reaches 0, set the shared state to TRANS_NONE. The unlockBtreeIfUnused() ** call below will unlock the pager. */ if( p->inTrans!=TRANS_NONE ){ clearAllSharedCacheTableLocks(p); pBt->nTransaction--; if( 0==pBt->nTransaction ){ pBt->inTransaction = TRANS_NONE; } } /* Set the current transaction state to TRANS_NONE and unlock the ** pager if this call closed the only read or write transaction. */ p->inTrans = TRANS_NONE; unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt); } btreeIntegrity(p); } /* ** Commit the transaction currently in progress. ** ** This routine implements the second phase of a 2-phase commit. The ** sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne() routine does the first phase and should ** be invoked prior to calling this routine. The sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne() ** routine did all the work of writing information out to disk and flushing the ** contents so that they are written onto the disk platter. All this ** routine has to do is delete or truncate or zero the header in the ** the rollback journal (which causes the transaction to commit) and ** drop locks. ** ** Normally, if an error occurs while the pager layer is attempting to ** finalize the underlying journal file, this function returns an error and ** the upper layer will attempt a rollback. However, if the second argument ** is non-zero then this b-tree transaction is part of a multi-file ** transaction. In this case, the transaction has already been committed ** (by deleting a master journal file) and the caller will ignore this ** functions return code. So, even if an error occurs in the pager layer, ** reset the b-tree objects internal state to indicate that the write ** transaction has been closed. This is quite safe, as the pager will have ** transitioned to the error state. ** ** This will release the write lock on the database file. If there ** are no active cursors, it also releases the read lock. */ int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseTwo(Btree *p, int bCleanup){ if( p->inTrans==TRANS_NONE ) return SQLITE_OK; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); btreeIntegrity(p); /* If the handle has a write-transaction open, commit the shared-btrees ** transaction and set the shared state to TRANS_READ. */ if( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ){ int rc; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( pBt->nTransaction>0 ); rc = sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseTwo(pBt->pPager); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && bCleanup==0 ){ sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } p->iDataVersion--; /* Compensate for pPager->iDataVersion++; */ pBt->inTransaction = TRANS_READ; btreeClearHasContent(pBt); } btreeEndTransaction(p); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Do both phases of a commit. */ int sqlite3BtreeCommit(Btree *p){ int rc; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne(p, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseTwo(p, 0); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** This routine sets the state to CURSOR_FAULT and the error ** code to errCode for every cursor on any BtShared that pBtree ** references. Or if the writeOnly flag is set to 1, then only ** trip write cursors and leave read cursors unchanged. ** ** Every cursor is a candidate to be tripped, including cursors ** that belong to other database connections that happen to be ** sharing the cache with pBtree. ** ** This routine gets called when a rollback occurs. If the writeOnly ** flag is true, then only write-cursors need be tripped - read-only ** cursors save their current positions so that they may continue ** following the rollback. Or, if writeOnly is false, all cursors are ** tripped. In general, writeOnly is false if the transaction being ** rolled back modified the database schema. In this case b-tree root ** pages may be moved or deleted from the database altogether, making ** it unsafe for read cursors to continue. ** ** If the writeOnly flag is true and an error is encountered while ** saving the current position of a read-only cursor, all cursors, ** including all read-cursors are tripped. ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned if successful, or if an error occurs while ** saving a cursor position, an SQLite error code. */ int sqlite3BtreeTripAllCursors(Btree *pBtree, int errCode, int writeOnly){ BtCursor *p; int rc = SQLITE_OK; assert( (writeOnly==0 || writeOnly==1) && BTCF_WriteFlag==1 ); if( pBtree ){ sqlite3BtreeEnter(pBtree); for(p=pBtree->pBt->pCursor; p; p=p->pNext){ if( writeOnly && (p->curFlags & BTCF_WriteFlag)==0 ){ if( p->eState==CURSOR_VALID || p->eState==CURSOR_SKIPNEXT ){ rc = saveCursorPosition(p); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ (void)sqlite3BtreeTripAllCursors(pBtree, rc, 0); break; } } }else{ sqlite3BtreeClearCursor(p); p->eState = CURSOR_FAULT; p->skipNext = errCode; } btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(p); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(pBtree); } return rc; } /* ** Rollback the transaction in progress. ** ** If tripCode is not SQLITE_OK then cursors will be invalidated (tripped). ** Only write cursors are tripped if writeOnly is true but all cursors are ** tripped if writeOnly is false. Any attempt to use ** a tripped cursor will result in an error. ** ** This will release the write lock on the database file. If there ** are no active cursors, it also releases the read lock. */ int sqlite3BtreeRollback(Btree *p, int tripCode, int writeOnly){ int rc; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; MemPage *pPage1; assert( writeOnly==1 || writeOnly==0 ); assert( tripCode==SQLITE_ABORT_ROLLBACK || tripCode==SQLITE_OK ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); if( tripCode==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = tripCode = saveAllCursors(pBt, 0, 0); if( rc ) writeOnly = 0; }else{ rc = SQLITE_OK; } if( tripCode ){ int rc2 = sqlite3BtreeTripAllCursors(p, tripCode, writeOnly); assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || (writeOnly==0 && rc2==SQLITE_OK) ); if( rc2!=SQLITE_OK ) rc = rc2; } btreeIntegrity(p); if( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ){ int rc2; assert( TRANS_WRITE==pBt->inTransaction ); rc2 = sqlite3PagerRollback(pBt->pPager); if( rc2!=SQLITE_OK ){ rc = rc2; } /* The rollback may have destroyed the pPage1->aData value. So ** call btreeGetPage() on page 1 again to make ** sure pPage1->aData is set correctly. */ if( btreeGetPage(pBt, 1, &pPage1, 0)==SQLITE_OK ){ int nPage = get4byte(28+(u8*)pPage1->aData); testcase( nPage==0 ); if( nPage==0 ) sqlite3PagerPagecount(pBt->pPager, &nPage); testcase( pBt->nPage!=nPage ); pBt->nPage = nPage; releasePageOne(pPage1); } assert( countValidCursors(pBt, 1)==0 ); pBt->inTransaction = TRANS_READ; btreeClearHasContent(pBt); } btreeEndTransaction(p); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** Start a statement subtransaction. The subtransaction can be rolled ** back independently of the main transaction. You must start a transaction ** before starting a subtransaction. The subtransaction is ended automatically ** if the main transaction commits or rolls back. ** ** Statement subtransactions are used around individual SQL statements ** that are contained within a BEGIN...COMMIT block. If a constraint ** error occurs within the statement, the effect of that one statement ** can be rolled back without having to rollback the entire transaction. ** ** A statement sub-transaction is implemented as an anonymous savepoint. The ** value passed as the second parameter is the total number of savepoints, ** including the new anonymous savepoint, open on the B-Tree. i.e. if there ** are no active savepoints and no other statement-transactions open, ** iStatement is 1. This anonymous savepoint can be released or rolled back ** using the sqlite3BtreeSavepoint() function. */ int sqlite3BtreeBeginStmt(Btree *p, int iStatement){ int rc; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 ); assert( iStatement>0 ); assert( iStatement>p->db->nSavepoint ); assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); /* At the pager level, a statement transaction is a savepoint with ** an index greater than all savepoints created explicitly using ** SQL statements. It is illegal to open, release or rollback any ** such savepoints while the statement transaction savepoint is active. */ rc = sqlite3PagerOpenSavepoint(pBt->pPager, iStatement); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** The second argument to this function, op, is always SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK ** or SAVEPOINT_RELEASE. This function either releases or rolls back the ** savepoint identified by parameter iSavepoint, depending on the value ** of op. ** ** Normally, iSavepoint is greater than or equal to zero. However, if op is ** SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK, then iSavepoint may also be -1. In this case the ** contents of the entire transaction are rolled back. This is different ** from a normal transaction rollback, as no locks are released and the ** transaction remains open. */ int sqlite3BtreeSavepoint(Btree *p, int op, int iSavepoint){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; if( p && p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( op==SAVEPOINT_RELEASE || op==SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK ); assert( iSavepoint>=0 || (iSavepoint==-1 && op==SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); if( op==SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK ){ rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, 0, 0); } if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = sqlite3PagerSavepoint(pBt->pPager, op, iSavepoint); } if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ if( iSavepoint<0 && (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_INITIALLY_EMPTY)!=0 ){ pBt->nPage = 0; } rc = newDatabase(pBt); pBt->nPage = get4byte(28 + pBt->pPage1->aData); /* The database size was written into the offset 28 of the header ** when the transaction started, so we know that the value at offset ** 28 is nonzero. */ assert( pBt->nPage>0 ); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } return rc; } /* ** Create a new cursor for the BTree whose root is on the page ** iTable. If a read-only cursor is requested, it is assumed that ** the caller already has at least a read-only transaction open ** on the database already. If a write-cursor is requested, then ** the caller is assumed to have an open write transaction. ** ** If the BTREE_WRCSR bit of wrFlag is clear, then the cursor can only ** be used for reading. If the BTREE_WRCSR bit is set, then the cursor ** can be used for reading or for writing if other conditions for writing ** are also met. These are the conditions that must be met in order ** for writing to be allowed: ** ** 1: The cursor must have been opened with wrFlag containing BTREE_WRCSR ** ** 2: Other database connections that share the same pager cache ** but which are not in the READ_UNCOMMITTED state may not have ** cursors open with wrFlag==0 on the same table. Otherwise ** the changes made by this write cursor would be visible to ** the read cursors in the other database connection. ** ** 3: The database must be writable (not on read-only media) ** ** 4: There must be an active transaction. ** ** The BTREE_FORDELETE bit of wrFlag may optionally be set if BTREE_WRCSR ** is set. If FORDELETE is set, that is a hint to the implementation that ** this cursor will only be used to seek to and delete entries of an index ** as part of a larger DELETE statement. The FORDELETE hint is not used by ** this implementation. But in a hypothetical alternative storage engine ** in which index entries are automatically deleted when corresponding table ** rows are deleted, the FORDELETE flag is a hint that all SEEK and DELETE ** operations on this cursor can be no-ops and all READ operations can ** return a null row (2-bytes: 0x01 0x00). ** ** No checking is done to make sure that page iTable really is the ** root page of a b-tree. If it is not, then the cursor acquired ** will not work correctly. ** ** It is assumed that the sqlite3BtreeCursorZero() has been called ** on pCur to initialize the memory space prior to invoking this routine. */ static int btreeCursor( Btree *p, /* The btree */ int iTable, /* Root page of table to open */ int wrFlag, /* 1 to write. 0 read-only */ struct KeyInfo *pKeyInfo, /* First arg to comparison function */ BtCursor *pCur /* Space for new cursor */ ){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; /* Shared b-tree handle */ BtCursor *pX; /* Looping over other all cursors */ assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( wrFlag==0 || wrFlag==BTREE_WRCSR || wrFlag==(BTREE_WRCSR|BTREE_FORDELETE) ); /* The following assert statements verify that if this is a sharable ** b-tree database, the connection is holding the required table locks, ** and that no other connection has any open cursor that conflicts with ** this lock. */ assert( hasSharedCacheTableLock(p, iTable, pKeyInfo!=0, (wrFlag?2:1)) ); assert( wrFlag==0 || !hasReadConflicts(p, iTable) ); /* Assert that the caller has opened the required transaction. */ assert( p->inTrans>TRANS_NONE ); assert( wrFlag==0 || p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( pBt->pPage1 && pBt->pPage1->aData ); assert( wrFlag==0 || (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 ); if( wrFlag ){ allocateTempSpace(pBt); if( pBt->pTmpSpace==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } if( iTable==1 && btreePagecount(pBt)==0 ){ assert( wrFlag==0 ); iTable = 0; } /* Now that no other errors can occur, finish filling in the BtCursor ** variables and link the cursor into the BtShared list. */ pCur->pgnoRoot = (Pgno)iTable; pCur->iPage = -1; pCur->pKeyInfo = pKeyInfo; pCur->pBtree = p; pCur->pBt = pBt; pCur->curFlags = wrFlag ? BTCF_WriteFlag : 0; pCur->curPagerFlags = wrFlag ? 0 : PAGER_GET_READONLY; /* If there are two or more cursors on the same btree, then all such ** cursors *must* have the BTCF_Multiple flag set. */ for(pX=pBt->pCursor; pX; pX=pX->pNext){ if( pX->pgnoRoot==(Pgno)iTable ){ pX->curFlags |= BTCF_Multiple; pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_Multiple; } } pCur->pNext = pBt->pCursor; pBt->pCursor = pCur; pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; return SQLITE_OK; } int sqlite3BtreeCursor( Btree *p, /* The btree */ int iTable, /* Root page of table to open */ int wrFlag, /* 1 to write. 0 read-only */ struct KeyInfo *pKeyInfo, /* First arg to xCompare() */ BtCursor *pCur /* Write new cursor here */ ){ int rc; if( iTable<1 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; }else{ sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = btreeCursor(p, iTable, wrFlag, pKeyInfo, pCur); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } return rc; } /* ** Return the size of a BtCursor object in bytes. ** ** This interfaces is needed so that users of cursors can preallocate ** sufficient storage to hold a cursor. The BtCursor object is opaque ** to users so they cannot do the sizeof() themselves - they must call ** this routine. */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorSize(void){ return ROUND8(sizeof(BtCursor)); } /* ** Initialize memory that will be converted into a BtCursor object. ** ** The simple approach here would be to memset() the entire object ** to zero. But it turns out that the apPage[] and aiIdx[] arrays ** do not need to be zeroed and they are large, so we can save a lot ** of run-time by skipping the initialization of those elements. */ void sqlite3BtreeCursorZero(BtCursor *p){ memset(p, 0, offsetof(BtCursor, BTCURSOR_FIRST_UNINIT)); } /* ** Close a cursor. The read lock on the database file is released ** when the last cursor is closed. */ int sqlite3BtreeCloseCursor(BtCursor *pCur){ Btree *pBtree = pCur->pBtree; if( pBtree ){ BtShared *pBt = pCur->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(pBtree); assert( pBt->pCursor!=0 ); if( pBt->pCursor==pCur ){ pBt->pCursor = pCur->pNext; }else{ BtCursor *pPrev = pBt->pCursor; do{ if( pPrev->pNext==pCur ){ pPrev->pNext = pCur->pNext; break; } pPrev = pPrev->pNext; }while( ALWAYS(pPrev) ); } btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(pCur); unlockBtreeIfUnused(pBt); sqlite3_free(pCur->aOverflow); sqlite3_free(pCur->pKey); sqlite3BtreeLeave(pBtree); } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Make sure the BtCursor* given in the argument has a valid ** BtCursor.info structure. If it is not already valid, call ** btreeParseCell() to fill it in. ** ** BtCursor.info is a cache of the information in the current cell. ** Using this cache reduces the number of calls to btreeParseCell(). */ #ifndef NDEBUG static int cellInfoEqual(CellInfo *a, CellInfo *b){ if( a->nKey!=b->nKey ) return 0; if( a->pPayload!=b->pPayload ) return 0; if( a->nPayload!=b->nPayload ) return 0; if( a->nLocal!=b->nLocal ) return 0; if( a->nSize!=b->nSize ) return 0; return 1; } static void assertCellInfo(BtCursor *pCur){ CellInfo info; memset(&info, 0, sizeof(info)); btreeParseCell(pCur->pPage, pCur->ix, &info); assert( CORRUPT_DB || cellInfoEqual(&info, &pCur->info) ); } #else #define assertCellInfo(x) #endif static SQLITE_NOINLINE void getCellInfo(BtCursor *pCur){ if( pCur->info.nSize==0 ){ pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_ValidNKey; btreeParseCell(pCur->pPage,pCur->ix,&pCur->info); }else{ assertCellInfo(pCur); } } #ifndef NDEBUG /* The next routine used only within assert() statements */ /* ** Return true if the given BtCursor is valid. A valid cursor is one ** that is currently pointing to a row in a (non-empty) table. ** This is a verification routine is used only within assert() statements. */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorIsValid(BtCursor *pCur){ return pCur && pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID; } #endif /* NDEBUG */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorIsValidNN(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( pCur!=0 ); return pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID; } /* ** Return the value of the integer key or "rowid" for a table btree. ** This routine is only valid for a cursor that is pointing into a ** ordinary table btree. If the cursor points to an index btree or ** is invalid, the result of this routine is undefined. */ i64 sqlite3BtreeIntegerKey(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->curIntKey ); getCellInfo(pCur); return pCur->info.nKey; } #ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_OFFSET_SQL_FUNC /* ** Return the offset into the database file for the start of the ** payload to which the cursor is pointing. */ i64 sqlite3BtreeOffset(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); getCellInfo(pCur); return (i64)pCur->pBt->pageSize*((i64)pCur->pPage->pgno - 1) + (i64)(pCur->info.pPayload - pCur->pPage->aData); } #endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_OFFSET_SQL_FUNC */ /* ** Return the number of bytes of payload for the entry that pCur is ** currently pointing to. For table btrees, this will be the amount ** of data. For index btrees, this will be the size of the key. ** ** The caller must guarantee that the cursor is pointing to a non-NULL ** valid entry. In other words, the calling procedure must guarantee ** that the cursor has Cursor.eState==CURSOR_VALID. */ u32 sqlite3BtreePayloadSize(BtCursor *pCur){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); getCellInfo(pCur); return pCur->info.nPayload; } /* ** Given the page number of an overflow page in the database (parameter ** ovfl), this function finds the page number of the next page in the ** linked list of overflow pages. If possible, it uses the auto-vacuum ** pointer-map data instead of reading the content of page ovfl to do so. ** ** If an error occurs an SQLite error code is returned. Otherwise: ** ** The page number of the next overflow page in the linked list is ** written to *pPgnoNext. If page ovfl is the last page in its linked ** list, *pPgnoNext is set to zero. ** ** If ppPage is not NULL, and a reference to the MemPage object corresponding ** to page number pOvfl was obtained, then *ppPage is set to point to that ** reference. It is the responsibility of the caller to call releasePage() ** on *ppPage to free the reference. In no reference was obtained (because ** the pointer-map was used to obtain the value for *pPgnoNext), then ** *ppPage is set to zero. */ static int getOverflowPage( BtShared *pBt, /* The database file */ Pgno ovfl, /* Current overflow page number */ MemPage **ppPage, /* OUT: MemPage handle (may be NULL) */ Pgno *pPgnoNext /* OUT: Next overflow page number */ ){ Pgno next = 0; MemPage *pPage = 0; int rc = SQLITE_OK; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert(pPgnoNext); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* Try to find the next page in the overflow list using the ** autovacuum pointer-map pages. Guess that the next page in ** the overflow list is page number (ovfl+1). If that guess turns ** out to be wrong, fall back to loading the data of page ** number ovfl to determine the next page number. */ if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ Pgno pgno; Pgno iGuess = ovfl+1; u8 eType; while( PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, iGuess) || iGuess==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ iGuess++; } if( iGuess<=btreePagecount(pBt) ){ rc = ptrmapGet(pBt, iGuess, &eType, &pgno); if( rc==SQLITE_OK && eType==PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2 && pgno==ovfl ){ next = iGuess; rc = SQLITE_DONE; } } } #endif assert( next==0 || rc==SQLITE_DONE ); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, ovfl, &pPage, (ppPage==0) ? PAGER_GET_READONLY : 0); assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || pPage==0 ); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ next = get4byte(pPage->aData); } } *pPgnoNext = next; if( ppPage ){ *ppPage = pPage; }else{ releasePage(pPage); } return (rc==SQLITE_DONE ? SQLITE_OK : rc); } /* ** Copy data from a buffer to a page, or from a page to a buffer. ** ** pPayload is a pointer to data stored on database page pDbPage. ** If argument eOp is false, then nByte bytes of data are copied ** from pPayload to the buffer pointed at by pBuf. If eOp is true, ** then sqlite3PagerWrite() is called on pDbPage and nByte bytes ** of data are copied from the buffer pBuf to pPayload. ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned on success, otherwise an error code. */ static int copyPayload( void *pPayload, /* Pointer to page data */ void *pBuf, /* Pointer to buffer */ int nByte, /* Number of bytes to copy */ int eOp, /* 0 -> copy from page, 1 -> copy to page */ DbPage *pDbPage /* Page containing pPayload */ ){ if( eOp ){ /* Copy data from buffer to page (a write operation) */ int rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } memcpy(pPayload, pBuf, nByte); }else{ /* Copy data from page to buffer (a read operation) */ memcpy(pBuf, pPayload, nByte); } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** This function is used to read or overwrite payload information ** for the entry that the pCur cursor is pointing to. The eOp ** argument is interpreted as follows: ** ** 0: The operation is a read. Populate the overflow cache. ** 1: The operation is a write. Populate the overflow cache. ** ** A total of "amt" bytes are read or written beginning at "offset". ** Data is read to or from the buffer pBuf. ** ** The content being read or written might appear on the main page ** or be scattered out on multiple overflow pages. ** ** If the current cursor entry uses one or more overflow pages ** this function may allocate space for and lazily populate ** the overflow page-list cache array (BtCursor.aOverflow). ** Subsequent calls use this cache to make seeking to the supplied offset ** more efficient. ** ** Once an overflow page-list cache has been allocated, it must be ** invalidated if some other cursor writes to the same table, or if ** the cursor is moved to a different row. Additionally, in auto-vacuum ** mode, the following events may invalidate an overflow page-list cache. ** ** * An incremental vacuum, ** * A commit in auto_vacuum="full" mode, ** * Creating a table (may require moving an overflow page). */ static int accessPayload( BtCursor *pCur, /* Cursor pointing to entry to read from */ u32 offset, /* Begin reading this far into payload */ u32 amt, /* Read this many bytes */ unsigned char *pBuf, /* Write the bytes into this buffer */ int eOp /* zero to read. non-zero to write. */ ){ unsigned char *aPayload; int rc = SQLITE_OK; int iIdx = 0; MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage; /* Btree page of current entry */ BtShared *pBt = pCur->pBt; /* Btree this cursor belongs to */ #ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ unsigned char * const pBufStart = pBuf; /* Start of original out buffer */ #endif assert( pPage ); assert( eOp==0 || eOp==1 ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->ixnCell ); assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); getCellInfo(pCur); aPayload = pCur->info.pPayload; assert( offset+amt <= pCur->info.nPayload ); assert( aPayload > pPage->aData ); if( (uptr)(aPayload - pPage->aData) > (pBt->usableSize - pCur->info.nLocal) ){ /* Trying to read or write past the end of the data is an error. The ** conditional above is really: ** &aPayload[pCur->info.nLocal] > &pPage->aData[pBt->usableSize] ** but is recast into its current form to avoid integer overflow problems */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } /* Check if data must be read/written to/from the btree page itself. */ if( offsetinfo.nLocal ){ int a = amt; if( a+offset>pCur->info.nLocal ){ a = pCur->info.nLocal - offset; } rc = copyPayload(&aPayload[offset], pBuf, a, eOp, pPage->pDbPage); offset = 0; pBuf += a; amt -= a; }else{ offset -= pCur->info.nLocal; } if( rc==SQLITE_OK && amt>0 ){ const u32 ovflSize = pBt->usableSize - 4; /* Bytes content per ovfl page */ Pgno nextPage; nextPage = get4byte(&aPayload[pCur->info.nLocal]); /* If the BtCursor.aOverflow[] has not been allocated, allocate it now. ** ** The aOverflow[] array is sized at one entry for each overflow page ** in the overflow chain. The page number of the first overflow page is ** stored in aOverflow[0], etc. A value of 0 in the aOverflow[] array ** means "not yet known" (the cache is lazily populated). */ if( (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidOvfl)==0 ){ int nOvfl = (pCur->info.nPayload-pCur->info.nLocal+ovflSize-1)/ovflSize; if( pCur->aOverflow==0 || nOvfl*(int)sizeof(Pgno) > sqlite3MallocSize(pCur->aOverflow) ){ Pgno *aNew = (Pgno*)sqlite3Realloc( pCur->aOverflow, nOvfl*2*sizeof(Pgno) ); if( aNew==0 ){ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; }else{ pCur->aOverflow = aNew; } } memset(pCur->aOverflow, 0, nOvfl*sizeof(Pgno)); pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_ValidOvfl; }else{ /* If the overflow page-list cache has been allocated and the ** entry for the first required overflow page is valid, skip ** directly to it. */ if( pCur->aOverflow[offset/ovflSize] ){ iIdx = (offset/ovflSize); nextPage = pCur->aOverflow[iIdx]; offset = (offset%ovflSize); } } assert( rc==SQLITE_OK && amt>0 ); while( nextPage ){ /* If required, populate the overflow page-list cache. */ assert( pCur->aOverflow[iIdx]==0 || pCur->aOverflow[iIdx]==nextPage || CORRUPT_DB ); pCur->aOverflow[iIdx] = nextPage; if( offset>=ovflSize ){ /* The only reason to read this page is to obtain the page ** number for the next page in the overflow chain. The page ** data is not required. So first try to lookup the overflow ** page-list cache, if any, then fall back to the getOverflowPage() ** function. */ assert( pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidOvfl ); assert( pCur->pBtree->db==pBt->db ); if( pCur->aOverflow[iIdx+1] ){ nextPage = pCur->aOverflow[iIdx+1]; }else{ rc = getOverflowPage(pBt, nextPage, 0, &nextPage); } offset -= ovflSize; }else{ /* Need to read this page properly. It contains some of the ** range of data that is being read (eOp==0) or written (eOp!=0). */ int a = amt; if( a + offset > ovflSize ){ a = ovflSize - offset; } #ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ /* If all the following are true: ** ** 1) this is a read operation, and ** 2) data is required from the start of this overflow page, and ** 3) there are no dirty pages in the page-cache ** 4) the database is file-backed, and ** 5) the page is not in the WAL file ** 6) at least 4 bytes have already been read into the output buffer ** ** then data can be read directly from the database file into the ** output buffer, bypassing the page-cache altogether. This speeds ** up loading large records that span many overflow pages. */ if( eOp==0 /* (1) */ && offset==0 /* (2) */ && sqlite3PagerDirectReadOk(pBt->pPager, nextPage) /* (3,4,5) */ && &pBuf[-4]>=pBufStart /* (6) */ ){ sqlite3_file *fd = sqlite3PagerFile(pBt->pPager); u8 aSave[4]; u8 *aWrite = &pBuf[-4]; assert( aWrite>=pBufStart ); /* due to (6) */ memcpy(aSave, aWrite, 4); rc = sqlite3OsRead(fd, aWrite, a+4, (i64)pBt->pageSize*(nextPage-1)); nextPage = get4byte(aWrite); memcpy(aWrite, aSave, 4); }else #endif { DbPage *pDbPage; rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pBt->pPager, nextPage, &pDbPage, (eOp==0 ? PAGER_GET_READONLY : 0) ); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ aPayload = sqlite3PagerGetData(pDbPage); nextPage = get4byte(aPayload); rc = copyPayload(&aPayload[offset+4], pBuf, a, eOp, pDbPage); sqlite3PagerUnref(pDbPage); offset = 0; } } amt -= a; if( amt==0 ) return rc; pBuf += a; } if( rc ) break; iIdx++; } } if( rc==SQLITE_OK && amt>0 ){ /* Overflow chain ends prematurely */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } return rc; } /* ** Read part of the payload for the row at which that cursor pCur is currently ** pointing. "amt" bytes will be transferred into pBuf[]. The transfer ** begins at "offset". ** ** pCur can be pointing to either a table or an index b-tree. ** If pointing to a table btree, then the content section is read. If ** pCur is pointing to an index b-tree then the key section is read. ** ** For sqlite3BtreePayload(), the caller must ensure that pCur is pointing ** to a valid row in the table. For sqlite3BtreePayloadChecked(), the ** cursor might be invalid or might need to be restored before being read. ** ** Return SQLITE_OK on success or an error code if anything goes ** wrong. An error is returned if "offset+amt" is larger than ** the available payload. */ int sqlite3BtreePayload(BtCursor *pCur, u32 offset, u32 amt, void *pBuf){ assert( cursorHoldsMutex(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->iPage>=0 && pCur->pPage ); assert( pCur->ixpPage->nCell ); return accessPayload(pCur, offset, amt, (unsigned char*)pBuf, 0); } /* ** This variant of sqlite3BtreePayload() works even if the cursor has not ** in the CURSOR_VALID state. It is only used by the sqlite3_blob_read() ** interface. */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB static SQLITE_NOINLINE int accessPayloadChecked( BtCursor *pCur, u32 offset, u32 amt, void *pBuf ){ int rc; if ( pCur->eState==CURSOR_INVALID ){ return SQLITE_ABORT; } assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); rc = btreeRestoreCursorPosition(pCur); return rc ? rc : accessPayload(pCur, offset, amt, pBuf, 0); } int sqlite3BtreePayloadChecked(BtCursor *pCur, u32 offset, u32 amt, void *pBuf){ if( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ){ assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); return accessPayload(pCur, offset, amt, pBuf, 0); }else{ return accessPayloadChecked(pCur, offset, amt, pBuf); } } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB */ /* ** Return a pointer to payload information from the entry that the ** pCur cursor is pointing to. The pointer is to the beginning of ** the key if index btrees (pPage->intKey==0) and is the data for ** table btrees (pPage->intKey==1). The number of bytes of available ** key/data is written into *pAmt. If *pAmt==0, then the value ** returned will not be a valid pointer. ** ** This routine is an optimization. It is common for the entire key ** and data to fit on the local page and for there to be no overflow ** pages. When that is so, this routine can be used to access the ** key and data without making a copy. If the key and/or data spills ** onto overflow pages, then accessPayload() must be used to reassemble ** the key/data and copy it into a preallocated buffer. ** ** The pointer returned by this routine looks directly into the cached ** page of the database. The data might change or move the next time ** any btree routine is called. */ static const void *fetchPayload( BtCursor *pCur, /* Cursor pointing to entry to read from */ u32 *pAmt /* Write the number of available bytes here */ ){ int amt; assert( pCur!=0 && pCur->iPage>=0 && pCur->pPage); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCur->pBtree->db->mutex) ); assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->ixpPage->nCell ); assert( pCur->info.nSize>0 ); assert( pCur->info.pPayload>pCur->pPage->aData || CORRUPT_DB ); assert( pCur->info.pPayloadpPage->aDataEnd ||CORRUPT_DB); amt = pCur->info.nLocal; if( amt>(int)(pCur->pPage->aDataEnd - pCur->info.pPayload) ){ /* There is too little space on the page for the expected amount ** of local content. Database must be corrupt. */ assert( CORRUPT_DB ); amt = MAX(0, (int)(pCur->pPage->aDataEnd - pCur->info.pPayload)); } *pAmt = (u32)amt; return (void*)pCur->info.pPayload; } /* ** For the entry that cursor pCur is point to, return as ** many bytes of the key or data as are available on the local ** b-tree page. Write the number of available bytes into *pAmt. ** ** The pointer returned is ephemeral. The key/data may move ** or be destroyed on the next call to any Btree routine, ** including calls from other threads against the same cache. ** Hence, a mutex on the BtShared should be held prior to calling ** this routine. ** ** These routines is used to get quick access to key and data ** in the common case where no overflow pages are used. */ const void *sqlite3BtreePayloadFetch(BtCursor *pCur, u32 *pAmt){ return fetchPayload(pCur, pAmt); } /* ** Move the cursor down to a new child page. The newPgno argument is the ** page number of the child page to move to. ** ** This function returns SQLITE_CORRUPT if the page-header flags field of ** the new child page does not match the flags field of the parent (i.e. ** if an intkey page appears to be the parent of a non-intkey page, or ** vice-versa). */ static int moveToChild(BtCursor *pCur, u32 newPgno){ BtShared *pBt = pCur->pBt; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->iPageiPage>=0 ); if( pCur->iPage>=(BTCURSOR_MAX_DEPTH-1) ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } pCur->info.nSize = 0; pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_ValidNKey|BTCF_ValidOvfl); pCur->aiIdx[pCur->iPage] = pCur->ix; pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage] = pCur->pPage; pCur->ix = 0; pCur->iPage++; return getAndInitPage(pBt, newPgno, &pCur->pPage, pCur, pCur->curPagerFlags); } #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* ** Page pParent is an internal (non-leaf) tree page. This function ** asserts that page number iChild is the left-child if the iIdx'th ** cell in page pParent. Or, if iIdx is equal to the total number of ** cells in pParent, that page number iChild is the right-child of ** the page. */ static void assertParentIndex(MemPage *pParent, int iIdx, Pgno iChild){ if( CORRUPT_DB ) return; /* The conditions tested below might not be true ** in a corrupt database */ assert( iIdx<=pParent->nCell ); if( iIdx==pParent->nCell ){ assert( get4byte(&pParent->aData[pParent->hdrOffset+8])==iChild ); }else{ assert( get4byte(findCell(pParent, iIdx))==iChild ); } } #else # define assertParentIndex(x,y,z) #endif /* ** Move the cursor up to the parent page. ** ** pCur->idx is set to the cell index that contains the pointer ** to the page we are coming from. If we are coming from the ** right-most child page then pCur->idx is set to one more than ** the largest cell index. */ static void moveToParent(BtCursor *pCur){ MemPage *pLeaf; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->iPage>0 ); assert( pCur->pPage ); assertParentIndex( pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage-1], pCur->aiIdx[pCur->iPage-1], pCur->pPage->pgno ); testcase( pCur->aiIdx[pCur->iPage-1] > pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage-1]->nCell ); pCur->info.nSize = 0; pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_ValidNKey|BTCF_ValidOvfl); pCur->ix = pCur->aiIdx[pCur->iPage-1]; pLeaf = pCur->pPage; pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[--pCur->iPage]; releasePageNotNull(pLeaf); } /* ** Move the cursor to point to the root page of its b-tree structure. ** ** If the table has a virtual root page, then the cursor is moved to point ** to the virtual root page instead of the actual root page. A table has a ** virtual root page when the actual root page contains no cells and a ** single child page. This can only happen with the table rooted at page 1. ** ** If the b-tree structure is empty, the cursor state is set to ** CURSOR_INVALID and this routine returns SQLITE_EMPTY. Otherwise, ** the cursor is set to point to the first cell located on the root ** (or virtual root) page and the cursor state is set to CURSOR_VALID. ** ** If this function returns successfully, it may be assumed that the ** page-header flags indicate that the [virtual] root-page is the expected ** kind of b-tree page (i.e. if when opening the cursor the caller did not ** specify a KeyInfo structure the flags byte is set to 0x05 or 0x0D, ** indicating a table b-tree, or if the caller did specify a KeyInfo ** structure the flags byte is set to 0x02 or 0x0A, indicating an index ** b-tree). */ static int moveToRoot(BtCursor *pCur){ MemPage *pRoot; int rc = SQLITE_OK; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( CURSOR_INVALID < CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ); assert( CURSOR_VALID < CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ); assert( CURSOR_FAULT > CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ); assert( pCur->eState < CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK || pCur->iPage<0 ); assert( pCur->pgnoRoot>0 || pCur->iPage<0 ); if( pCur->iPage>=0 ){ if( pCur->iPage ){ releasePageNotNull(pCur->pPage); while( --pCur->iPage ){ releasePageNotNull(pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage]); } pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[0]; goto skip_init; } }else if( pCur->pgnoRoot==0 ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; return SQLITE_EMPTY; }else{ assert( pCur->iPage==(-1) ); if( pCur->eState>=CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ){ if( pCur->eState==CURSOR_FAULT ){ assert( pCur->skipNext!=SQLITE_OK ); return pCur->skipNext; } sqlite3BtreeClearCursor(pCur); } rc = getAndInitPage(pCur->pBtree->pBt, pCur->pgnoRoot, &pCur->pPage, 0, pCur->curPagerFlags); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; return rc; } pCur->iPage = 0; pCur->curIntKey = pCur->pPage->intKey; } pRoot = pCur->pPage; assert( pRoot->pgno==pCur->pgnoRoot ); /* If pCur->pKeyInfo is not NULL, then the caller that opened this cursor ** expected to open it on an index b-tree. Otherwise, if pKeyInfo is ** NULL, the caller expects a table b-tree. If this is not the case, ** return an SQLITE_CORRUPT error. ** ** Earlier versions of SQLite assumed that this test could not fail ** if the root page was already loaded when this function was called (i.e. ** if pCur->iPage>=0). But this is not so if the database is corrupted ** in such a way that page pRoot is linked into a second b-tree table ** (or the freelist). */ assert( pRoot->intKey==1 || pRoot->intKey==0 ); if( pRoot->isInit==0 || (pCur->pKeyInfo==0)!=pRoot->intKey ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pCur->pPage); } skip_init: pCur->ix = 0; pCur->info.nSize = 0; pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_AtLast|BTCF_ValidNKey|BTCF_ValidOvfl); pRoot = pCur->pPage; if( pRoot->nCell>0 ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_VALID; }else if( !pRoot->leaf ){ Pgno subpage; if( pRoot->pgno!=1 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; subpage = get4byte(&pRoot->aData[pRoot->hdrOffset+8]); pCur->eState = CURSOR_VALID; rc = moveToChild(pCur, subpage); }else{ pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; rc = SQLITE_EMPTY; } return rc; } /* ** Move the cursor down to the left-most leaf entry beneath the ** entry to which it is currently pointing. ** ** The left-most leaf is the one with the smallest key - the first ** in ascending order. */ static int moveToLeftmost(BtCursor *pCur){ Pgno pgno; int rc = SQLITE_OK; MemPage *pPage; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); while( rc==SQLITE_OK && !(pPage = pCur->pPage)->leaf ){ assert( pCur->ixnCell ); pgno = get4byte(findCell(pPage, pCur->ix)); rc = moveToChild(pCur, pgno); } return rc; } /* ** Move the cursor down to the right-most leaf entry beneath the ** page to which it is currently pointing. Notice the difference ** between moveToLeftmost() and moveToRightmost(). moveToLeftmost() ** finds the left-most entry beneath the *entry* whereas moveToRightmost() ** finds the right-most entry beneath the *page*. ** ** The right-most entry is the one with the largest key - the last ** key in ascending order. */ static int moveToRightmost(BtCursor *pCur){ Pgno pgno; int rc = SQLITE_OK; MemPage *pPage = 0; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); while( !(pPage = pCur->pPage)->leaf ){ pgno = get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8]); pCur->ix = pPage->nCell; rc = moveToChild(pCur, pgno); if( rc ) return rc; } pCur->ix = pPage->nCell-1; assert( pCur->info.nSize==0 ); assert( (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidNKey)==0 ); return SQLITE_OK; } /* Move the cursor to the first entry in the table. Return SQLITE_OK ** on success. Set *pRes to 0 if the cursor actually points to something ** or set *pRes to 1 if the table is empty. */ int sqlite3BtreeFirst(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){ int rc; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCur->pBtree->db->mutex) ); rc = moveToRoot(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ assert( pCur->pPage->nCell>0 ); *pRes = 0; rc = moveToLeftmost(pCur); }else if( rc==SQLITE_EMPTY ){ assert( pCur->pgnoRoot==0 || pCur->pPage->nCell==0 ); *pRes = 1; rc = SQLITE_OK; } return rc; } /* ** This function is a no-op if cursor pCur does not point to a valid row. ** Otherwise, if pCur is valid, configure it so that the next call to ** sqlite3BtreeNext() is a no-op. */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC void sqlite3BtreeSkipNext(BtCursor *pCur){ /* We believe that the cursor must always be in the valid state when ** this routine is called, but the proof is difficult, so we add an ** ALWaYS() test just in case we are wrong. */ if( ALWAYS(pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID) ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_SKIPNEXT; pCur->skipNext = 1; } } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC */ /* Move the cursor to the last entry in the table. Return SQLITE_OK ** on success. Set *pRes to 0 if the cursor actually points to something ** or set *pRes to 1 if the table is empty. */ int sqlite3BtreeLast(BtCursor *pCur, int *pRes){ int rc; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCur->pBtree->db->mutex) ); /* If the cursor already points to the last entry, this is a no-op. */ if( CURSOR_VALID==pCur->eState && (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_AtLast)!=0 ){ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG /* This block serves to assert() that the cursor really does point ** to the last entry in the b-tree. */ int ii; for(ii=0; iiiPage; ii++){ assert( pCur->aiIdx[ii]==pCur->apPage[ii]->nCell ); } assert( pCur->ix==pCur->pPage->nCell-1 ); assert( pCur->pPage->leaf ); #endif return SQLITE_OK; } rc = moveToRoot(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); *pRes = 0; rc = moveToRightmost(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_AtLast; }else{ pCur->curFlags &= ~BTCF_AtLast; } }else if( rc==SQLITE_EMPTY ){ assert( pCur->pgnoRoot==0 || pCur->pPage->nCell==0 ); *pRes = 1; rc = SQLITE_OK; } return rc; } /* Move the cursor so that it points to an entry near the key ** specified by pIdxKey or intKey. Return a success code. ** ** For INTKEY tables, the intKey parameter is used. pIdxKey ** must be NULL. For index tables, pIdxKey is used and intKey ** is ignored. ** ** If an exact match is not found, then the cursor is always ** left pointing at a leaf page which would hold the entry if it ** were present. The cursor might point to an entry that comes ** before or after the key. ** ** An integer is written into *pRes which is the result of ** comparing the key with the entry to which the cursor is ** pointing. The meaning of the integer written into ** *pRes is as follows: ** ** *pRes<0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that ** is smaller than intKey/pIdxKey or if the table is empty ** and the cursor is therefore left point to nothing. ** ** *pRes==0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that ** exactly matches intKey/pIdxKey. ** ** *pRes>0 The cursor is left pointing at an entry that ** is larger than intKey/pIdxKey. ** ** For index tables, the pIdxKey->eqSeen field is set to 1 if there ** exists an entry in the table that exactly matches pIdxKey. */ int sqlite3BtreeMovetoUnpacked( BtCursor *pCur, /* The cursor to be moved */ UnpackedRecord *pIdxKey, /* Unpacked index key */ i64 intKey, /* The table key */ int biasRight, /* If true, bias the search to the high end */ int *pRes /* Write search results here */ ){ int rc; RecordCompare xRecordCompare; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCur->pBtree->db->mutex) ); assert( pRes ); assert( (pIdxKey==0)==(pCur->pKeyInfo==0) ); assert( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID || (pIdxKey==0)==(pCur->curIntKey!=0) ); /* If the cursor is already positioned at the point we are trying ** to move to, then just return without doing any work */ if( pIdxKey==0 && pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID && (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidNKey)!=0 ){ if( pCur->info.nKey==intKey ){ *pRes = 0; return SQLITE_OK; } if( pCur->info.nKeycurFlags & BTCF_AtLast)!=0 ){ *pRes = -1; return SQLITE_OK; } /* If the requested key is one more than the previous key, then ** try to get there using sqlite3BtreeNext() rather than a full ** binary search. This is an optimization only. The correct answer ** is still obtained without this case, only a little more slowely */ if( pCur->info.nKey+1==intKey && !pCur->skipNext ){ *pRes = 0; rc = sqlite3BtreeNext(pCur, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ getCellInfo(pCur); if( pCur->info.nKey==intKey ){ return SQLITE_OK; } }else if( rc==SQLITE_DONE ){ rc = SQLITE_OK; }else{ return rc; } } } } if( pIdxKey ){ xRecordCompare = sqlite3VdbeFindCompare(pIdxKey); pIdxKey->errCode = 0; assert( pIdxKey->default_rc==1 || pIdxKey->default_rc==0 || pIdxKey->default_rc==-1 ); }else{ xRecordCompare = 0; /* All keys are integers */ } rc = moveToRoot(pCur); if( rc ){ if( rc==SQLITE_EMPTY ){ assert( pCur->pgnoRoot==0 || pCur->pPage->nCell==0 ); *pRes = -1; return SQLITE_OK; } return rc; } assert( pCur->pPage ); assert( pCur->pPage->isInit ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( pCur->pPage->nCell > 0 ); assert( pCur->iPage==0 || pCur->apPage[0]->intKey==pCur->curIntKey ); assert( pCur->curIntKey || pIdxKey ); for(;;){ int lwr, upr, idx, c; Pgno chldPg; MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage; u8 *pCell; /* Pointer to current cell in pPage */ /* pPage->nCell must be greater than zero. If this is the root-page ** the cursor would have been INVALID above and this for(;;) loop ** not run. If this is not the root-page, then the moveToChild() routine ** would have already detected db corruption. Similarly, pPage must ** be the right kind (index or table) of b-tree page. Otherwise ** a moveToChild() or moveToRoot() call would have detected corruption. */ assert( pPage->nCell>0 ); assert( pPage->intKey==(pIdxKey==0) ); lwr = 0; upr = pPage->nCell-1; assert( biasRight==0 || biasRight==1 ); idx = upr>>(1-biasRight); /* idx = biasRight ? upr : (lwr+upr)/2; */ pCur->ix = (u16)idx; if( xRecordCompare==0 ){ for(;;){ i64 nCellKey; pCell = findCellPastPtr(pPage, idx); if( pPage->intKeyLeaf ){ while( 0x80 <= *(pCell++) ){ if( pCell>=pPage->aDataEnd ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } } } getVarint(pCell, (u64*)&nCellKey); if( nCellKeyupr ){ c = -1; break; } }else if( nCellKey>intKey ){ upr = idx-1; if( lwr>upr ){ c = +1; break; } }else{ assert( nCellKey==intKey ); pCur->ix = (u16)idx; if( !pPage->leaf ){ lwr = idx; goto moveto_next_layer; }else{ pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_ValidNKey; pCur->info.nKey = nCellKey; pCur->info.nSize = 0; *pRes = 0; return SQLITE_OK; } } assert( lwr+upr>=0 ); idx = (lwr+upr)>>1; /* idx = (lwr+upr)/2; */ } }else{ for(;;){ int nCell; /* Size of the pCell cell in bytes */ pCell = findCellPastPtr(pPage, idx); /* The maximum supported page-size is 65536 bytes. This means that ** the maximum number of record bytes stored on an index B-Tree ** page is less than 16384 bytes and may be stored as a 2-byte ** varint. This information is used to attempt to avoid parsing ** the entire cell by checking for the cases where the record is ** stored entirely within the b-tree page by inspecting the first ** 2 bytes of the cell. */ nCell = pCell[0]; if( nCell<=pPage->max1bytePayload ){ /* This branch runs if the record-size field of the cell is a ** single byte varint and the record fits entirely on the main ** b-tree page. */ testcase( pCell+nCell+1==pPage->aDataEnd ); c = xRecordCompare(nCell, (void*)&pCell[1], pIdxKey); }else if( !(pCell[1] & 0x80) && (nCell = ((nCell&0x7f)<<7) + pCell[1])<=pPage->maxLocal ){ /* The record-size field is a 2 byte varint and the record ** fits entirely on the main b-tree page. */ testcase( pCell+nCell+2==pPage->aDataEnd ); c = xRecordCompare(nCell, (void*)&pCell[2], pIdxKey); }else{ /* The record flows over onto one or more overflow pages. In ** this case the whole cell needs to be parsed, a buffer allocated ** and accessPayload() used to retrieve the record into the ** buffer before VdbeRecordCompare() can be called. ** ** If the record is corrupt, the xRecordCompare routine may read ** up to two varints past the end of the buffer. An extra 18 ** bytes of padding is allocated at the end of the buffer in ** case this happens. */ void *pCellKey; u8 * const pCellBody = pCell - pPage->childPtrSize; pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCellBody, &pCur->info); nCell = (int)pCur->info.nKey; testcase( nCell<0 ); /* True if key size is 2^32 or more */ testcase( nCell==0 ); /* Invalid key size: 0x80 0x80 0x00 */ testcase( nCell==1 ); /* Invalid key size: 0x80 0x80 0x01 */ testcase( nCell==2 ); /* Minimum legal index key size */ if( nCell<2 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); goto moveto_finish; } pCellKey = sqlite3Malloc( nCell+18 ); if( pCellKey==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; goto moveto_finish; } pCur->ix = (u16)idx; rc = accessPayload(pCur, 0, nCell, (unsigned char*)pCellKey, 0); pCur->curFlags &= ~BTCF_ValidOvfl; if( rc ){ sqlite3_free(pCellKey); goto moveto_finish; } c = xRecordCompare(nCell, pCellKey, pIdxKey); sqlite3_free(pCellKey); } assert( (pIdxKey->errCode!=SQLITE_CORRUPT || c==0) && (pIdxKey->errCode!=SQLITE_NOMEM || pCur->pBtree->db->mallocFailed) ); if( c<0 ){ lwr = idx+1; }else if( c>0 ){ upr = idx-1; }else{ assert( c==0 ); *pRes = 0; rc = SQLITE_OK; pCur->ix = (u16)idx; if( pIdxKey->errCode ) rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto moveto_finish; } if( lwr>upr ) break; assert( lwr+upr>=0 ); idx = (lwr+upr)>>1; /* idx = (lwr+upr)/2 */ } } assert( lwr==upr+1 || (pPage->intKey && !pPage->leaf) ); assert( pPage->isInit ); if( pPage->leaf ){ assert( pCur->ixpPage->nCell ); pCur->ix = (u16)idx; *pRes = c; rc = SQLITE_OK; goto moveto_finish; } moveto_next_layer: if( lwr>=pPage->nCell ){ chldPg = get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8]); }else{ chldPg = get4byte(findCell(pPage, lwr)); } pCur->ix = (u16)lwr; rc = moveToChild(pCur, chldPg); if( rc ) break; } moveto_finish: pCur->info.nSize = 0; assert( (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidOvfl)==0 ); return rc; } /* ** Return TRUE if the cursor is not pointing at an entry of the table. ** ** TRUE will be returned after a call to sqlite3BtreeNext() moves ** past the last entry in the table or sqlite3BtreePrev() moves past ** the first entry. TRUE is also returned if the table is empty. */ int sqlite3BtreeEof(BtCursor *pCur){ /* TODO: What if the cursor is in CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK but all table entries ** have been deleted? This API will need to change to return an error code ** as well as the boolean result value. */ return (CURSOR_VALID!=pCur->eState); } /* ** Return an estimate for the number of rows in the table that pCur is ** pointing to. Return a negative number if no estimate is currently ** available. */ i64 sqlite3BtreeRowCountEst(BtCursor *pCur){ i64 n; u8 i; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCur->pBtree->db->mutex) ); /* Currently this interface is only called by the OP_IfSmaller ** opcode, and it that case the cursor will always be valid and ** will always point to a leaf node. */ if( NEVER(pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID) ) return -1; if( NEVER(pCur->pPage->leaf==0) ) return -1; n = pCur->pPage->nCell; for(i=0; iiPage; i++){ n *= pCur->apPage[i]->nCell; } return n; } /* ** Advance the cursor to the next entry in the database. ** Return value: ** ** SQLITE_OK success ** SQLITE_DONE cursor is already pointing at the last element ** otherwise some kind of error occurred ** ** The main entry point is sqlite3BtreeNext(). That routine is optimized ** for the common case of merely incrementing the cell counter BtCursor.aiIdx ** to the next cell on the current page. The (slower) btreeNext() helper ** routine is called when it is necessary to move to a different page or ** to restore the cursor. ** ** If bit 0x01 of the F argument in sqlite3BtreeNext(C,F) is 1, then the ** cursor corresponds to an SQL index and this routine could have been ** skipped if the SQL index had been a unique index. The F argument ** is a hint to the implement. SQLite btree implementation does not use ** this hint, but COMDB2 does. */ static SQLITE_NOINLINE int btreeNext(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc; int idx; MemPage *pPage; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->skipNext==0 || pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ); if( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ){ assert( (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidOvfl)==0 ); rc = restoreCursorPosition(pCur); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } if( CURSOR_INVALID==pCur->eState ){ return SQLITE_DONE; } if( pCur->skipNext ){ assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID || pCur->eState==CURSOR_SKIPNEXT ); pCur->eState = CURSOR_VALID; if( pCur->skipNext>0 ){ pCur->skipNext = 0; return SQLITE_OK; } pCur->skipNext = 0; } } pPage = pCur->pPage; idx = ++pCur->ix; if( !pPage->isInit ){ /* The only known way for this to happen is for there to be a ** recursive SQL function that does a DELETE operation as part of a ** SELECT which deletes content out from under an active cursor ** in a corrupt database file where the table being DELETE-ed from ** has pages in common with the table being queried. See TH3 ** module cov1/btree78.test testcase 220 (2018-06-08) for an ** example. */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } /* If the database file is corrupt, it is possible for the value of idx ** to be invalid here. This can only occur if a second cursor modifies ** the page while cursor pCur is holding a reference to it. Which can ** only happen if the database is corrupt in such a way as to link the ** page into more than one b-tree structure. */ testcase( idx>pPage->nCell ); if( idx>=pPage->nCell ){ if( !pPage->leaf ){ rc = moveToChild(pCur, get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8])); if( rc ) return rc; return moveToLeftmost(pCur); } do{ if( pCur->iPage==0 ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; return SQLITE_DONE; } moveToParent(pCur); pPage = pCur->pPage; }while( pCur->ix>=pPage->nCell ); if( pPage->intKey ){ return sqlite3BtreeNext(pCur, 0); }else{ return SQLITE_OK; } } if( pPage->leaf ){ return SQLITE_OK; }else{ return moveToLeftmost(pCur); } } int sqlite3BtreeNext(BtCursor *pCur, int flags){ MemPage *pPage; UNUSED_PARAMETER( flags ); /* Used in COMDB2 but not native SQLite */ assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( flags==0 || flags==1 ); assert( pCur->skipNext==0 || pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ); pCur->info.nSize = 0; pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_ValidNKey|BTCF_ValidOvfl); if( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ) return btreeNext(pCur); pPage = pCur->pPage; if( (++pCur->ix)>=pPage->nCell ){ pCur->ix--; return btreeNext(pCur); } if( pPage->leaf ){ return SQLITE_OK; }else{ return moveToLeftmost(pCur); } } /* ** Step the cursor to the back to the previous entry in the database. ** Return values: ** ** SQLITE_OK success ** SQLITE_DONE the cursor is already on the first element of the table ** otherwise some kind of error occurred ** ** The main entry point is sqlite3BtreePrevious(). That routine is optimized ** for the common case of merely decrementing the cell counter BtCursor.aiIdx ** to the previous cell on the current page. The (slower) btreePrevious() ** helper routine is called when it is necessary to move to a different page ** or to restore the cursor. ** ** If bit 0x01 of the F argument to sqlite3BtreePrevious(C,F) is 1, then ** the cursor corresponds to an SQL index and this routine could have been ** skipped if the SQL index had been a unique index. The F argument is a ** hint to the implement. The native SQLite btree implementation does not ** use this hint, but COMDB2 does. */ static SQLITE_NOINLINE int btreePrevious(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc; MemPage *pPage; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pCur->skipNext==0 || pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ); assert( (pCur->curFlags & (BTCF_AtLast|BTCF_ValidOvfl|BTCF_ValidNKey))==0 ); assert( pCur->info.nSize==0 ); if( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ){ rc = restoreCursorPosition(pCur); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } if( CURSOR_INVALID==pCur->eState ){ return SQLITE_DONE; } if( pCur->skipNext ){ assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID || pCur->eState==CURSOR_SKIPNEXT ); pCur->eState = CURSOR_VALID; if( pCur->skipNext<0 ){ pCur->skipNext = 0; return SQLITE_OK; } pCur->skipNext = 0; } } pPage = pCur->pPage; assert( pPage->isInit ); if( !pPage->leaf ){ int idx = pCur->ix; rc = moveToChild(pCur, get4byte(findCell(pPage, idx))); if( rc ) return rc; rc = moveToRightmost(pCur); }else{ while( pCur->ix==0 ){ if( pCur->iPage==0 ){ pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; return SQLITE_DONE; } moveToParent(pCur); } assert( pCur->info.nSize==0 ); assert( (pCur->curFlags & (BTCF_ValidOvfl))==0 ); pCur->ix--; pPage = pCur->pPage; if( pPage->intKey && !pPage->leaf ){ rc = sqlite3BtreePrevious(pCur, 0); }else{ rc = SQLITE_OK; } } return rc; } int sqlite3BtreePrevious(BtCursor *pCur, int flags){ assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( flags==0 || flags==1 ); assert( pCur->skipNext==0 || pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ); UNUSED_PARAMETER( flags ); /* Used in COMDB2 but not native SQLite */ pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_AtLast|BTCF_ValidOvfl|BTCF_ValidNKey); pCur->info.nSize = 0; if( pCur->eState!=CURSOR_VALID || pCur->ix==0 || pCur->pPage->leaf==0 ){ return btreePrevious(pCur); } pCur->ix--; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Allocate a new page from the database file. ** ** The new page is marked as dirty. (In other words, sqlite3PagerWrite() ** has already been called on the new page.) The new page has also ** been referenced and the calling routine is responsible for calling ** sqlite3PagerUnref() on the new page when it is done. ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned on success. Any other return value indicates ** an error. *ppPage is set to NULL in the event of an error. ** ** If the "nearby" parameter is not 0, then an effort is made to ** locate a page close to the page number "nearby". This can be used in an ** attempt to keep related pages close to each other in the database file, ** which in turn can make database access faster. ** ** If the eMode parameter is BTALLOC_EXACT and the nearby page exists ** anywhere on the free-list, then it is guaranteed to be returned. If ** eMode is BTALLOC_LT then the page returned will be less than or equal ** to nearby if any such page exists. If eMode is BTALLOC_ANY then there ** are no restrictions on which page is returned. */ static int allocateBtreePage( BtShared *pBt, /* The btree */ MemPage **ppPage, /* Store pointer to the allocated page here */ Pgno *pPgno, /* Store the page number here */ Pgno nearby, /* Search for a page near this one */ u8 eMode /* BTALLOC_EXACT, BTALLOC_LT, or BTALLOC_ANY */ ){ MemPage *pPage1; int rc; u32 n; /* Number of pages on the freelist */ u32 k; /* Number of leaves on the trunk of the freelist */ MemPage *pTrunk = 0; MemPage *pPrevTrunk = 0; Pgno mxPage; /* Total size of the database file */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( eMode==BTALLOC_ANY || (nearby>0 && IfNotOmitAV(pBt->autoVacuum)) ); pPage1 = pBt->pPage1; mxPage = btreePagecount(pBt); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-05119-02637 The 4-byte big-endian integer at offset 36 ** stores stores the total number of pages on the freelist. */ n = get4byte(&pPage1->aData[36]); testcase( n==mxPage-1 ); if( n>=mxPage ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } if( n>0 ){ /* There are pages on the freelist. Reuse one of those pages. */ Pgno iTrunk; u8 searchList = 0; /* If the free-list must be searched for 'nearby' */ u32 nSearch = 0; /* Count of the number of search attempts */ /* If eMode==BTALLOC_EXACT and a query of the pointer-map ** shows that the page 'nearby' is somewhere on the free-list, then ** the entire-list will be searched for that page. */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( eMode==BTALLOC_EXACT ){ if( nearby<=mxPage ){ u8 eType; assert( nearby>0 ); assert( pBt->autoVacuum ); rc = ptrmapGet(pBt, nearby, &eType, 0); if( rc ) return rc; if( eType==PTRMAP_FREEPAGE ){ searchList = 1; } } }else if( eMode==BTALLOC_LE ){ searchList = 1; } #endif /* Decrement the free-list count by 1. Set iTrunk to the index of the ** first free-list trunk page. iPrevTrunk is initially 1. */ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; put4byte(&pPage1->aData[36], n-1); /* The code within this loop is run only once if the 'searchList' variable ** is not true. Otherwise, it runs once for each trunk-page on the ** free-list until the page 'nearby' is located (eMode==BTALLOC_EXACT) ** or until a page less than 'nearby' is located (eMode==BTALLOC_LT) */ do { pPrevTrunk = pTrunk; if( pPrevTrunk ){ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-01506-11053 The first integer on a freelist trunk page ** is the page number of the next freelist trunk page in the list or ** zero if this is the last freelist trunk page. */ iTrunk = get4byte(&pPrevTrunk->aData[0]); }else{ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-59841-13798 The 4-byte big-endian integer at offset 32 ** stores the page number of the first page of the freelist, or zero if ** the freelist is empty. */ iTrunk = get4byte(&pPage1->aData[32]); } testcase( iTrunk==mxPage ); if( iTrunk>mxPage || nSearch++ > n ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(pPrevTrunk ? pPrevTrunk->pgno : 1); }else{ rc = btreeGetUnusedPage(pBt, iTrunk, &pTrunk, 0); } if( rc ){ pTrunk = 0; goto end_allocate_page; } assert( pTrunk!=0 ); assert( pTrunk->aData!=0 ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-13523-04394 The second integer on a freelist trunk page ** is the number of leaf page pointers to follow. */ k = get4byte(&pTrunk->aData[4]); if( k==0 && !searchList ){ /* The trunk has no leaves and the list is not being searched. ** So extract the trunk page itself and use it as the newly ** allocated page */ assert( pPrevTrunk==0 ); rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc ){ goto end_allocate_page; } *pPgno = iTrunk; memcpy(&pPage1->aData[32], &pTrunk->aData[0], 4); *ppPage = pTrunk; pTrunk = 0; TRACE(("ALLOCATE: %d trunk - %d free pages left\n", *pPgno, n-1)); }else if( k>(u32)(pBt->usableSize/4 - 2) ){ /* Value of k is out of range. Database corruption */ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(iTrunk); goto end_allocate_page; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM }else if( searchList && (nearby==iTrunk || (iTrunkpDbPage); if( rc ){ goto end_allocate_page; } if( k==0 ){ if( !pPrevTrunk ){ memcpy(&pPage1->aData[32], &pTrunk->aData[0], 4); }else{ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPrevTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto end_allocate_page; } memcpy(&pPrevTrunk->aData[0], &pTrunk->aData[0], 4); } }else{ /* The trunk page is required by the caller but it contains ** pointers to free-list leaves. The first leaf becomes a trunk ** page in this case. */ MemPage *pNewTrunk; Pgno iNewTrunk = get4byte(&pTrunk->aData[8]); if( iNewTrunk>mxPage ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(iTrunk); goto end_allocate_page; } testcase( iNewTrunk==mxPage ); rc = btreeGetUnusedPage(pBt, iNewTrunk, &pNewTrunk, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto end_allocate_page; } rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pNewTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(pNewTrunk); goto end_allocate_page; } memcpy(&pNewTrunk->aData[0], &pTrunk->aData[0], 4); put4byte(&pNewTrunk->aData[4], k-1); memcpy(&pNewTrunk->aData[8], &pTrunk->aData[12], (k-1)*4); releasePage(pNewTrunk); if( !pPrevTrunk ){ assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage1->pDbPage) ); put4byte(&pPage1->aData[32], iNewTrunk); }else{ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPrevTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc ){ goto end_allocate_page; } put4byte(&pPrevTrunk->aData[0], iNewTrunk); } } pTrunk = 0; TRACE(("ALLOCATE: %d trunk - %d free pages left\n", *pPgno, n-1)); #endif }else if( k>0 ){ /* Extract a leaf from the trunk */ u32 closest; Pgno iPage; unsigned char *aData = pTrunk->aData; if( nearby>0 ){ u32 i; closest = 0; if( eMode==BTALLOC_LE ){ for(i=0; imxPage ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(iTrunk); goto end_allocate_page; } testcase( iPage==mxPage ); if( !searchList || (iPage==nearby || (iPagepgno, n-1)); rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc ) goto end_allocate_page; if( closestpDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(*ppPage); *ppPage = 0; } } searchList = 0; } } releasePage(pPrevTrunk); pPrevTrunk = 0; }while( searchList ); }else{ /* There are no pages on the freelist, so append a new page to the ** database image. ** ** Normally, new pages allocated by this block can be requested from the ** pager layer with the 'no-content' flag set. This prevents the pager ** from trying to read the pages content from disk. However, if the ** current transaction has already run one or more incremental-vacuum ** steps, then the page we are about to allocate may contain content ** that is required in the event of a rollback. In this case, do ** not set the no-content flag. This causes the pager to load and journal ** the current page content before overwriting it. ** ** Note that the pager will not actually attempt to load or journal ** content for any page that really does lie past the end of the database ** file on disk. So the effects of disabling the no-content optimization ** here are confined to those pages that lie between the end of the ** database image and the end of the database file. */ int bNoContent = (0==IfNotOmitAV(pBt->bDoTruncate))? PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT:0; rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; pBt->nPage++; if( pBt->nPage==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ) pBt->nPage++; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum && PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, pBt->nPage) ){ /* If *pPgno refers to a pointer-map page, allocate two new pages ** at the end of the file instead of one. The first allocated page ** becomes a new pointer-map page, the second is used by the caller. */ MemPage *pPg = 0; TRACE(("ALLOCATE: %d from end of file (pointer-map page)\n", pBt->nPage)); assert( pBt->nPage!=PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ); rc = btreeGetUnusedPage(pBt, pBt->nPage, &pPg, bNoContent); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPg->pDbPage); releasePage(pPg); } if( rc ) return rc; pBt->nPage++; if( pBt->nPage==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ pBt->nPage++; } } #endif put4byte(28 + (u8*)pBt->pPage1->aData, pBt->nPage); *pPgno = pBt->nPage; assert( *pPgno!=PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ); rc = btreeGetUnusedPage(pBt, *pPgno, ppPage, bNoContent); if( rc ) return rc; rc = sqlite3PagerWrite((*ppPage)->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(*ppPage); *ppPage = 0; } TRACE(("ALLOCATE: %d from end of file\n", *pPgno)); } assert( *pPgno!=PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ); end_allocate_page: releasePage(pTrunk); releasePage(pPrevTrunk); assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || sqlite3PagerPageRefcount((*ppPage)->pDbPage)<=1 ); assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || (*ppPage)->isInit==0 ); return rc; } /* ** This function is used to add page iPage to the database file free-list. ** It is assumed that the page is not already a part of the free-list. ** ** The value passed as the second argument to this function is optional. ** If the caller happens to have a pointer to the MemPage object ** corresponding to page iPage handy, it may pass it as the second value. ** Otherwise, it may pass NULL. ** ** If a pointer to a MemPage object is passed as the second argument, ** its reference count is not altered by this function. */ static int freePage2(BtShared *pBt, MemPage *pMemPage, Pgno iPage){ MemPage *pTrunk = 0; /* Free-list trunk page */ Pgno iTrunk = 0; /* Page number of free-list trunk page */ MemPage *pPage1 = pBt->pPage1; /* Local reference to page 1 */ MemPage *pPage; /* Page being freed. May be NULL. */ int rc; /* Return Code */ int nFree; /* Initial number of pages on free-list */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( CORRUPT_DB || iPage>1 ); assert( !pMemPage || pMemPage->pgno==iPage ); if( iPage<2 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; if( pMemPage ){ pPage = pMemPage; sqlite3PagerRef(pPage->pDbPage); }else{ pPage = btreePageLookup(pBt, iPage); } /* Increment the free page count on pPage1 */ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc ) goto freepage_out; nFree = get4byte(&pPage1->aData[36]); put4byte(&pPage1->aData[36], nFree+1); if( pBt->btsFlags & BTS_SECURE_DELETE ){ /* If the secure_delete option is enabled, then ** always fully overwrite deleted information with zeros. */ if( (!pPage && ((rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, iPage, &pPage, 0))!=0) ) || ((rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage))!=0) ){ goto freepage_out; } memset(pPage->aData, 0, pPage->pBt->pageSize); } /* If the database supports auto-vacuum, write an entry in the pointer-map ** to indicate that the page is free. */ if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, iPage, PTRMAP_FREEPAGE, 0, &rc); if( rc ) goto freepage_out; } /* Now manipulate the actual database free-list structure. There are two ** possibilities. If the free-list is currently empty, or if the first ** trunk page in the free-list is full, then this page will become a ** new free-list trunk page. Otherwise, it will become a leaf of the ** first trunk page in the current free-list. This block tests if it ** is possible to add the page as a new free-list leaf. */ if( nFree!=0 ){ u32 nLeaf; /* Initial number of leaf cells on trunk page */ iTrunk = get4byte(&pPage1->aData[32]); rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, iTrunk, &pTrunk, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto freepage_out; } nLeaf = get4byte(&pTrunk->aData[4]); assert( pBt->usableSize>32 ); if( nLeaf > (u32)pBt->usableSize/4 - 2 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto freepage_out; } if( nLeaf < (u32)pBt->usableSize/4 - 8 ){ /* In this case there is room on the trunk page to insert the page ** being freed as a new leaf. ** ** Note that the trunk page is not really full until it contains ** usableSize/4 - 2 entries, not usableSize/4 - 8 entries as we have ** coded. But due to a coding error in versions of SQLite prior to ** 3.6.0, databases with freelist trunk pages holding more than ** usableSize/4 - 8 entries will be reported as corrupt. In order ** to maintain backwards compatibility with older versions of SQLite, ** we will continue to restrict the number of entries to usableSize/4 - 8 ** for now. At some point in the future (once everyone has upgraded ** to 3.6.0 or later) we should consider fixing the conditional above ** to read "usableSize/4-2" instead of "usableSize/4-8". ** ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-19920-11576 However, newer versions of SQLite still ** avoid using the last six entries in the freelist trunk page array in ** order that database files created by newer versions of SQLite can be ** read by older versions of SQLite. */ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pTrunk->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ put4byte(&pTrunk->aData[4], nLeaf+1); put4byte(&pTrunk->aData[8+nLeaf*4], iPage); if( pPage && (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_SECURE_DELETE)==0 ){ sqlite3PagerDontWrite(pPage->pDbPage); } rc = btreeSetHasContent(pBt, iPage); } TRACE(("FREE-PAGE: %d leaf on trunk page %d\n",pPage->pgno,pTrunk->pgno)); goto freepage_out; } } /* If control flows to this point, then it was not possible to add the ** the page being freed as a leaf page of the first trunk in the free-list. ** Possibly because the free-list is empty, or possibly because the ** first trunk in the free-list is full. Either way, the page being freed ** will become the new first trunk page in the free-list. */ if( pPage==0 && SQLITE_OK!=(rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, iPage, &pPage, 0)) ){ goto freepage_out; } rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto freepage_out; } put4byte(pPage->aData, iTrunk); put4byte(&pPage->aData[4], 0); put4byte(&pPage1->aData[32], iPage); TRACE(("FREE-PAGE: %d new trunk page replacing %d\n", pPage->pgno, iTrunk)); freepage_out: if( pPage ){ pPage->isInit = 0; } releasePage(pPage); releasePage(pTrunk); return rc; } static void freePage(MemPage *pPage, int *pRC){ if( (*pRC)==SQLITE_OK ){ *pRC = freePage2(pPage->pBt, pPage, pPage->pgno); } } /* ** Free any overflow pages associated with the given Cell. Store ** size information about the cell in pInfo. */ static int clearCell( MemPage *pPage, /* The page that contains the Cell */ unsigned char *pCell, /* First byte of the Cell */ CellInfo *pInfo /* Size information about the cell */ ){ BtShared *pBt; Pgno ovflPgno; int rc; int nOvfl; u32 ovflPageSize; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, pInfo); if( pInfo->nLocal==pInfo->nPayload ){ return SQLITE_OK; /* No overflow pages. Return without doing anything */ } testcase( pCell + pInfo->nSize == pPage->aDataEnd ); testcase( pCell + (pInfo->nSize-1) == pPage->aDataEnd ); if( pCell + pInfo->nSize > pPage->aDataEnd ){ /* Cell extends past end of page */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_PAGE(pPage); } ovflPgno = get4byte(pCell + pInfo->nSize - 4); pBt = pPage->pBt; assert( pBt->usableSize > 4 ); ovflPageSize = pBt->usableSize - 4; nOvfl = (pInfo->nPayload - pInfo->nLocal + ovflPageSize - 1)/ovflPageSize; assert( nOvfl>0 || (CORRUPT_DB && (pInfo->nPayload + ovflPageSize)btreePagecount(pBt) ){ /* 0 is not a legal page number and page 1 cannot be an ** overflow page. Therefore if ovflPgno<2 or past the end of the ** file the database must be corrupt. */ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } if( nOvfl ){ rc = getOverflowPage(pBt, ovflPgno, &pOvfl, &iNext); if( rc ) return rc; } if( ( pOvfl || ((pOvfl = btreePageLookup(pBt, ovflPgno))!=0) ) && sqlite3PagerPageRefcount(pOvfl->pDbPage)!=1 ){ /* There is no reason any cursor should have an outstanding reference ** to an overflow page belonging to a cell that is being deleted/updated. ** So if there exists more than one reference to this page, then it ** must not really be an overflow page and the database must be corrupt. ** It is helpful to detect this before calling freePage2(), as ** freePage2() may zero the page contents if secure-delete mode is ** enabled. If this 'overflow' page happens to be a page that the ** caller is iterating through or using in some other way, this ** can be problematic. */ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; }else{ rc = freePage2(pBt, pOvfl, ovflPgno); } if( pOvfl ){ sqlite3PagerUnref(pOvfl->pDbPage); } if( rc ) return rc; ovflPgno = iNext; } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Create the byte sequence used to represent a cell on page pPage ** and write that byte sequence into pCell[]. Overflow pages are ** allocated and filled in as necessary. The calling procedure ** is responsible for making sure sufficient space has been allocated ** for pCell[]. ** ** Note that pCell does not necessary need to point to the pPage->aData ** area. pCell might point to some temporary storage. The cell will ** be constructed in this temporary area then copied into pPage->aData ** later. */ static int fillInCell( MemPage *pPage, /* The page that contains the cell */ unsigned char *pCell, /* Complete text of the cell */ const BtreePayload *pX, /* Payload with which to construct the cell */ int *pnSize /* Write cell size here */ ){ int nPayload; const u8 *pSrc; int nSrc, n, rc, mn; int spaceLeft; MemPage *pToRelease; unsigned char *pPrior; unsigned char *pPayload; BtShared *pBt; Pgno pgnoOvfl; int nHeader; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); /* pPage is not necessarily writeable since pCell might be auxiliary ** buffer space that is separate from the pPage buffer area */ assert( pCellaData || pCell>=&pPage->aData[pPage->pBt->pageSize] || sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); /* Fill in the header. */ nHeader = pPage->childPtrSize; if( pPage->intKey ){ nPayload = pX->nData + pX->nZero; pSrc = pX->pData; nSrc = pX->nData; assert( pPage->intKeyLeaf ); /* fillInCell() only called for leaves */ nHeader += putVarint32(&pCell[nHeader], nPayload); nHeader += putVarint(&pCell[nHeader], *(u64*)&pX->nKey); }else{ assert( pX->nKey<=0x7fffffff && pX->pKey!=0 ); nSrc = nPayload = (int)pX->nKey; pSrc = pX->pKey; nHeader += putVarint32(&pCell[nHeader], nPayload); } /* Fill in the payload */ pPayload = &pCell[nHeader]; if( nPayload<=pPage->maxLocal ){ /* This is the common case where everything fits on the btree page ** and no overflow pages are required. */ n = nHeader + nPayload; testcase( n==3 ); testcase( n==4 ); if( n<4 ) n = 4; *pnSize = n; assert( nSrc<=nPayload ); testcase( nSrcminLocal; n = mn + (nPayload - mn) % (pPage->pBt->usableSize - 4); testcase( n==pPage->maxLocal ); testcase( n==pPage->maxLocal+1 ); if( n > pPage->maxLocal ) n = mn; spaceLeft = n; *pnSize = n + nHeader + 4; pPrior = &pCell[nHeader+n]; pToRelease = 0; pgnoOvfl = 0; pBt = pPage->pBt; /* At this point variables should be set as follows: ** ** nPayload Total payload size in bytes ** pPayload Begin writing payload here ** spaceLeft Space available at pPayload. If nPayload>spaceLeft, ** that means content must spill into overflow pages. ** *pnSize Size of the local cell (not counting overflow pages) ** pPrior Where to write the pgno of the first overflow page ** ** Use a call to btreeParseCellPtr() to verify that the values above ** were computed correctly. */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG { CellInfo info; pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, &info); assert( nHeader==(int)(info.pPayload - pCell) ); assert( info.nKey==pX->nKey ); assert( *pnSize == info.nSize ); assert( spaceLeft == info.nLocal ); } #endif /* Write the payload into the local Cell and any extra into overflow pages */ while( 1 ){ n = nPayload; if( n>spaceLeft ) n = spaceLeft; /* If pToRelease is not zero than pPayload points into the data area ** of pToRelease. Make sure pToRelease is still writeable. */ assert( pToRelease==0 || sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pToRelease->pDbPage) ); /* If pPayload is part of the data area of pPage, then make sure pPage ** is still writeable */ assert( pPayloadaData || pPayload>=&pPage->aData[pBt->pageSize] || sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); if( nSrc>=n ){ memcpy(pPayload, pSrc, n); }else if( nSrc>0 ){ n = nSrc; memcpy(pPayload, pSrc, n); }else{ memset(pPayload, 0, n); } nPayload -= n; if( nPayload<=0 ) break; pPayload += n; pSrc += n; nSrc -= n; spaceLeft -= n; if( spaceLeft==0 ){ MemPage *pOvfl = 0; #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM Pgno pgnoPtrmap = pgnoOvfl; /* Overflow page pointer-map entry page */ if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ do{ pgnoOvfl++; } while( PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, pgnoOvfl) || pgnoOvfl==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ); } #endif rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pOvfl, &pgnoOvfl, pgnoOvfl, 0); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* If the database supports auto-vacuum, and the second or subsequent ** overflow page is being allocated, add an entry to the pointer-map ** for that page now. ** ** If this is the first overflow page, then write a partial entry ** to the pointer-map. If we write nothing to this pointer-map slot, ** then the optimistic overflow chain processing in clearCell() ** may misinterpret the uninitialized values and delete the ** wrong pages from the database. */ if( pBt->autoVacuum && rc==SQLITE_OK ){ u8 eType = (pgnoPtrmap?PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2:PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1); ptrmapPut(pBt, pgnoOvfl, eType, pgnoPtrmap, &rc); if( rc ){ releasePage(pOvfl); } } #endif if( rc ){ releasePage(pToRelease); return rc; } /* If pToRelease is not zero than pPrior points into the data area ** of pToRelease. Make sure pToRelease is still writeable. */ assert( pToRelease==0 || sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pToRelease->pDbPage) ); /* If pPrior is part of the data area of pPage, then make sure pPage ** is still writeable */ assert( pPrioraData || pPrior>=&pPage->aData[pBt->pageSize] || sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); put4byte(pPrior, pgnoOvfl); releasePage(pToRelease); pToRelease = pOvfl; pPrior = pOvfl->aData; put4byte(pPrior, 0); pPayload = &pOvfl->aData[4]; spaceLeft = pBt->usableSize - 4; } } releasePage(pToRelease); return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Remove the i-th cell from pPage. This routine effects pPage only. ** The cell content is not freed or deallocated. It is assumed that ** the cell content has been copied someplace else. This routine just ** removes the reference to the cell from pPage. ** ** "sz" must be the number of bytes in the cell. */ static void dropCell(MemPage *pPage, int idx, int sz, int *pRC){ u32 pc; /* Offset to cell content of cell being deleted */ u8 *data; /* pPage->aData */ u8 *ptr; /* Used to move bytes around within data[] */ int rc; /* The return code */ int hdr; /* Beginning of the header. 0 most pages. 100 page 1 */ if( *pRC ) return; assert( idx>=0 && idxnCell ); assert( CORRUPT_DB || sz==cellSize(pPage, idx) ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); data = pPage->aData; ptr = &pPage->aCellIdx[2*idx]; pc = get2byte(ptr); hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; testcase( pc==get2byte(&data[hdr+5]) ); testcase( pc+sz==pPage->pBt->usableSize ); if( pc+sz > pPage->pBt->usableSize ){ *pRC = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; return; } rc = freeSpace(pPage, pc, sz); if( rc ){ *pRC = rc; return; } pPage->nCell--; if( pPage->nCell==0 ){ memset(&data[hdr+1], 0, 4); data[hdr+7] = 0; put2byte(&data[hdr+5], pPage->pBt->usableSize); pPage->nFree = pPage->pBt->usableSize - pPage->hdrOffset - pPage->childPtrSize - 8; }else{ memmove(ptr, ptr+2, 2*(pPage->nCell - idx)); put2byte(&data[hdr+3], pPage->nCell); pPage->nFree += 2; } } /* ** Insert a new cell on pPage at cell index "i". pCell points to the ** content of the cell. ** ** If the cell content will fit on the page, then put it there. If it ** will not fit, then make a copy of the cell content into pTemp if ** pTemp is not null. Regardless of pTemp, allocate a new entry ** in pPage->apOvfl[] and make it point to the cell content (either ** in pTemp or the original pCell) and also record its index. ** Allocating a new entry in pPage->aCell[] implies that ** pPage->nOverflow is incremented. ** ** *pRC must be SQLITE_OK when this routine is called. */ static void insertCell( MemPage *pPage, /* Page into which we are copying */ int i, /* New cell becomes the i-th cell of the page */ u8 *pCell, /* Content of the new cell */ int sz, /* Bytes of content in pCell */ u8 *pTemp, /* Temp storage space for pCell, if needed */ Pgno iChild, /* If non-zero, replace first 4 bytes with this value */ int *pRC /* Read and write return code from here */ ){ int idx = 0; /* Where to write new cell content in data[] */ int j; /* Loop counter */ u8 *data; /* The content of the whole page */ u8 *pIns; /* The point in pPage->aCellIdx[] where no cell inserted */ assert( *pRC==SQLITE_OK ); assert( i>=0 && i<=pPage->nCell+pPage->nOverflow ); assert( MX_CELL(pPage->pBt)<=10921 ); assert( pPage->nCell<=MX_CELL(pPage->pBt) || CORRUPT_DB ); assert( pPage->nOverflow<=ArraySize(pPage->apOvfl) ); assert( ArraySize(pPage->apOvfl)==ArraySize(pPage->aiOvfl) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); /* The cell should normally be sized correctly. However, when moving a ** malformed cell from a leaf page to an interior page, if the cell size ** wanted to be less than 4 but got rounded up to 4 on the leaf, then size ** might be less than 8 (leaf-size + pointer) on the interior node. Hence ** the term after the || in the following assert(). */ assert( sz==pPage->xCellSize(pPage, pCell) || (sz==8 && iChild>0) ); if( pPage->nOverflow || sz+2>pPage->nFree ){ if( pTemp ){ memcpy(pTemp, pCell, sz); pCell = pTemp; } if( iChild ){ put4byte(pCell, iChild); } j = pPage->nOverflow++; /* Comparison against ArraySize-1 since we hold back one extra slot ** as a contingency. In other words, never need more than 3 overflow ** slots but 4 are allocated, just to be safe. */ assert( j < ArraySize(pPage->apOvfl)-1 ); pPage->apOvfl[j] = pCell; pPage->aiOvfl[j] = (u16)i; /* When multiple overflows occur, they are always sequential and in ** sorted order. This invariants arise because multiple overflows can ** only occur when inserting divider cells into the parent page during ** balancing, and the dividers are adjacent and sorted. */ assert( j==0 || pPage->aiOvfl[j-1]<(u16)i ); /* Overflows in sorted order */ assert( j==0 || i==pPage->aiOvfl[j-1]+1 ); /* Overflows are sequential */ }else{ int rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ *pRC = rc; return; } assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pPage->pDbPage) ); data = pPage->aData; assert( &data[pPage->cellOffset]==pPage->aCellIdx ); rc = allocateSpace(pPage, sz, &idx); if( rc ){ *pRC = rc; return; } /* The allocateSpace() routine guarantees the following properties ** if it returns successfully */ assert( idx >= 0 ); assert( idx >= pPage->cellOffset+2*pPage->nCell+2 || CORRUPT_DB ); assert( idx+sz <= (int)pPage->pBt->usableSize ); pPage->nFree -= (u16)(2 + sz); memcpy(&data[idx], pCell, sz); if( iChild ){ put4byte(&data[idx], iChild); } pIns = pPage->aCellIdx + i*2; memmove(pIns+2, pIns, 2*(pPage->nCell - i)); put2byte(pIns, idx); pPage->nCell++; /* increment the cell count */ if( (++data[pPage->hdrOffset+4])==0 ) data[pPage->hdrOffset+3]++; assert( get2byte(&data[pPage->hdrOffset+3])==pPage->nCell ); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pPage->pBt->autoVacuum ){ /* The cell may contain a pointer to an overflow page. If so, write ** the entry for the overflow page into the pointer map. */ ptrmapPutOvflPtr(pPage, pCell, pRC); } #endif } } /* ** A CellArray object contains a cache of pointers and sizes for a ** consecutive sequence of cells that might be held on multiple pages. */ typedef struct CellArray CellArray; struct CellArray { int nCell; /* Number of cells in apCell[] */ MemPage *pRef; /* Reference page */ u8 **apCell; /* All cells begin balanced */ u16 *szCell; /* Local size of all cells in apCell[] */ }; /* ** Make sure the cell sizes at idx, idx+1, ..., idx+N-1 have been ** computed. */ static void populateCellCache(CellArray *p, int idx, int N){ assert( idx>=0 && idx+N<=p->nCell ); while( N>0 ){ assert( p->apCell[idx]!=0 ); if( p->szCell[idx]==0 ){ p->szCell[idx] = p->pRef->xCellSize(p->pRef, p->apCell[idx]); }else{ assert( CORRUPT_DB || p->szCell[idx]==p->pRef->xCellSize(p->pRef, p->apCell[idx]) ); } idx++; N--; } } /* ** Return the size of the Nth element of the cell array */ static SQLITE_NOINLINE u16 computeCellSize(CellArray *p, int N){ assert( N>=0 && NnCell ); assert( p->szCell[N]==0 ); p->szCell[N] = p->pRef->xCellSize(p->pRef, p->apCell[N]); return p->szCell[N]; } static u16 cachedCellSize(CellArray *p, int N){ assert( N>=0 && NnCell ); if( p->szCell[N] ) return p->szCell[N]; return computeCellSize(p, N); } /* ** Array apCell[] contains pointers to nCell b-tree page cells. The ** szCell[] array contains the size in bytes of each cell. This function ** replaces the current contents of page pPg with the contents of the cell ** array. ** ** Some of the cells in apCell[] may currently be stored in pPg. This ** function works around problems caused by this by making a copy of any ** such cells before overwriting the page data. ** ** The MemPage.nFree field is invalidated by this function. It is the ** responsibility of the caller to set it correctly. */ static int rebuildPage( MemPage *pPg, /* Edit this page */ int nCell, /* Final number of cells on page */ u8 **apCell, /* Array of cells */ u16 *szCell /* Array of cell sizes */ ){ const int hdr = pPg->hdrOffset; /* Offset of header on pPg */ u8 * const aData = pPg->aData; /* Pointer to data for pPg */ const int usableSize = pPg->pBt->usableSize; u8 * const pEnd = &aData[usableSize]; int i; u8 *pCellptr = pPg->aCellIdx; u8 *pTmp = sqlite3PagerTempSpace(pPg->pBt->pPager); u8 *pData; i = get2byte(&aData[hdr+5]); memcpy(&pTmp[i], &aData[i], usableSize - i); pData = pEnd; for(i=0; i(uptr)pEnd ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; pCell = &pTmp[pCell - aData]; } pData -= szCell[i]; put2byte(pCellptr, (pData - aData)); pCellptr += 2; if( pData < pCellptr ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; memcpy(pData, pCell, szCell[i]); assert( szCell[i]==pPg->xCellSize(pPg, pCell) || CORRUPT_DB ); testcase( szCell[i]!=pPg->xCellSize(pPg,pCell) ); } /* The pPg->nFree field is now set incorrectly. The caller will fix it. */ pPg->nCell = nCell; pPg->nOverflow = 0; put2byte(&aData[hdr+1], 0); put2byte(&aData[hdr+3], pPg->nCell); put2byte(&aData[hdr+5], pData - aData); aData[hdr+7] = 0x00; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Array apCell[] contains nCell pointers to b-tree cells. Array szCell ** contains the size in bytes of each such cell. This function attempts to ** add the cells stored in the array to page pPg. If it cannot (because ** the page needs to be defragmented before the cells will fit), non-zero ** is returned. Otherwise, if the cells are added successfully, zero is ** returned. ** ** Argument pCellptr points to the first entry in the cell-pointer array ** (part of page pPg) to populate. After cell apCell[0] is written to the ** page body, a 16-bit offset is written to pCellptr. And so on, for each ** cell in the array. It is the responsibility of the caller to ensure ** that it is safe to overwrite this part of the cell-pointer array. ** ** When this function is called, *ppData points to the start of the ** content area on page pPg. If the size of the content area is extended, ** *ppData is updated to point to the new start of the content area ** before returning. ** ** Finally, argument pBegin points to the byte immediately following the ** end of the space required by this page for the cell-pointer area (for ** all cells - not just those inserted by the current call). If the content ** area must be extended to before this point in order to accomodate all ** cells in apCell[], then the cells do not fit and non-zero is returned. */ static int pageInsertArray( MemPage *pPg, /* Page to add cells to */ u8 *pBegin, /* End of cell-pointer array */ u8 **ppData, /* IN/OUT: Page content -area pointer */ u8 *pCellptr, /* Pointer to cell-pointer area */ int iFirst, /* Index of first cell to add */ int nCell, /* Number of cells to add to pPg */ CellArray *pCArray /* Array of cells */ ){ int i; u8 *aData = pPg->aData; u8 *pData = *ppData; int iEnd = iFirst + nCell; assert( CORRUPT_DB || pPg->hdrOffset==0 ); /* Never called on page 1 */ for(i=iFirst; iapCell[i] will never overlap on a well-formed ** database. But they might for a corrupt database. Hence use memmove() ** since memcpy() sends SIGABORT with overlapping buffers on OpenBSD */ assert( (pSlot+sz)<=pCArray->apCell[i] || pSlot>=(pCArray->apCell[i]+sz) || CORRUPT_DB ); memmove(pSlot, pCArray->apCell[i], sz); put2byte(pCellptr, (pSlot - aData)); pCellptr += 2; } *ppData = pData; return 0; } /* ** Array apCell[] contains nCell pointers to b-tree cells. Array szCell ** contains the size in bytes of each such cell. This function adds the ** space associated with each cell in the array that is currently stored ** within the body of pPg to the pPg free-list. The cell-pointers and other ** fields of the page are not updated. ** ** This function returns the total number of cells added to the free-list. */ static int pageFreeArray( MemPage *pPg, /* Page to edit */ int iFirst, /* First cell to delete */ int nCell, /* Cells to delete */ CellArray *pCArray /* Array of cells */ ){ u8 * const aData = pPg->aData; u8 * const pEnd = &aData[pPg->pBt->usableSize]; u8 * const pStart = &aData[pPg->hdrOffset + 8 + pPg->childPtrSize]; int nRet = 0; int i; int iEnd = iFirst + nCell; u8 *pFree = 0; int szFree = 0; for(i=iFirst; iapCell[i]; if( SQLITE_WITHIN(pCell, pStart, pEnd) ){ int sz; /* No need to use cachedCellSize() here. The sizes of all cells that ** are to be freed have already been computing while deciding which ** cells need freeing */ sz = pCArray->szCell[i]; assert( sz>0 ); if( pFree!=(pCell + sz) ){ if( pFree ){ assert( pFree>aData && (pFree - aData)<65536 ); freeSpace(pPg, (u16)(pFree - aData), szFree); } pFree = pCell; szFree = sz; if( pFree+sz>pEnd ) return 0; }else{ pFree = pCell; szFree += sz; } nRet++; } } if( pFree ){ assert( pFree>aData && (pFree - aData)<65536 ); freeSpace(pPg, (u16)(pFree - aData), szFree); } return nRet; } /* ** apCell[] and szCell[] contains pointers to and sizes of all cells in the ** pages being balanced. The current page, pPg, has pPg->nCell cells starting ** with apCell[iOld]. After balancing, this page should hold nNew cells ** starting at apCell[iNew]. ** ** This routine makes the necessary adjustments to pPg so that it contains ** the correct cells after being balanced. ** ** The pPg->nFree field is invalid when this function returns. It is the ** responsibility of the caller to set it correctly. */ static int editPage( MemPage *pPg, /* Edit this page */ int iOld, /* Index of first cell currently on page */ int iNew, /* Index of new first cell on page */ int nNew, /* Final number of cells on page */ CellArray *pCArray /* Array of cells and sizes */ ){ u8 * const aData = pPg->aData; const int hdr = pPg->hdrOffset; u8 *pBegin = &pPg->aCellIdx[nNew * 2]; int nCell = pPg->nCell; /* Cells stored on pPg */ u8 *pData; u8 *pCellptr; int i; int iOldEnd = iOld + pPg->nCell + pPg->nOverflow; int iNewEnd = iNew + nNew; #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG u8 *pTmp = sqlite3PagerTempSpace(pPg->pBt->pPager); memcpy(pTmp, aData, pPg->pBt->usableSize); #endif /* Remove cells from the start and end of the page */ if( iOldaCellIdx, &pPg->aCellIdx[nShift*2], nCell*2); nCell -= nShift; } if( iNewEnd < iOldEnd ){ nCell -= pageFreeArray(pPg, iNewEnd, iOldEnd - iNewEnd, pCArray); } pData = &aData[get2byteNotZero(&aData[hdr+5])]; if( pDataaCellIdx; memmove(&pCellptr[nAdd*2], pCellptr, nCell*2); if( pageInsertArray( pPg, pBegin, &pData, pCellptr, iNew, nAdd, pCArray ) ) goto editpage_fail; nCell += nAdd; } /* Add any overflow cells */ for(i=0; inOverflow; i++){ int iCell = (iOld + pPg->aiOvfl[i]) - iNew; if( iCell>=0 && iCellaCellIdx[iCell * 2]; memmove(&pCellptr[2], pCellptr, (nCell - iCell) * 2); nCell++; if( pageInsertArray( pPg, pBegin, &pData, pCellptr, iCell+iNew, 1, pCArray ) ) goto editpage_fail; } } /* Append cells to the end of the page */ pCellptr = &pPg->aCellIdx[nCell*2]; if( pageInsertArray( pPg, pBegin, &pData, pCellptr, iNew+nCell, nNew-nCell, pCArray ) ) goto editpage_fail; pPg->nCell = nNew; pPg->nOverflow = 0; put2byte(&aData[hdr+3], pPg->nCell); put2byte(&aData[hdr+5], pData - aData); #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG for(i=0; iapCell[i+iNew]; int iOff = get2byteAligned(&pPg->aCellIdx[i*2]); if( SQLITE_WITHIN(pCell, aData, &aData[pPg->pBt->usableSize]) ){ pCell = &pTmp[pCell - aData]; } assert( 0==memcmp(pCell, &aData[iOff], pCArray->pRef->xCellSize(pCArray->pRef, pCArray->apCell[i+iNew])) ); } #endif return SQLITE_OK; editpage_fail: /* Unable to edit this page. Rebuild it from scratch instead. */ populateCellCache(pCArray, iNew, nNew); return rebuildPage(pPg, nNew, &pCArray->apCell[iNew], &pCArray->szCell[iNew]); } /* ** The following parameters determine how many adjacent pages get involved ** in a balancing operation. NN is the number of neighbors on either side ** of the page that participate in the balancing operation. NB is the ** total number of pages that participate, including the target page and ** NN neighbors on either side. ** ** The minimum value of NN is 1 (of course). Increasing NN above 1 ** (to 2 or 3) gives a modest improvement in SELECT and DELETE performance ** in exchange for a larger degradation in INSERT and UPDATE performance. ** The value of NN appears to give the best results overall. */ #define NN 1 /* Number of neighbors on either side of pPage */ #define NB (NN*2+1) /* Total pages involved in the balance */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_QUICKBALANCE /* ** This version of balance() handles the common special case where ** a new entry is being inserted on the extreme right-end of the ** tree, in other words, when the new entry will become the largest ** entry in the tree. ** ** Instead of trying to balance the 3 right-most leaf pages, just add ** a new page to the right-hand side and put the one new entry in ** that page. This leaves the right side of the tree somewhat ** unbalanced. But odds are that we will be inserting new entries ** at the end soon afterwards so the nearly empty page will quickly ** fill up. On average. ** ** pPage is the leaf page which is the right-most page in the tree. ** pParent is its parent. pPage must have a single overflow entry ** which is also the right-most entry on the page. ** ** The pSpace buffer is used to store a temporary copy of the divider ** cell that will be inserted into pParent. Such a cell consists of a 4 ** byte page number followed by a variable length integer. In other ** words, at most 13 bytes. Hence the pSpace buffer must be at ** least 13 bytes in size. */ static int balance_quick(MemPage *pParent, MemPage *pPage, u8 *pSpace){ BtShared *const pBt = pPage->pBt; /* B-Tree Database */ MemPage *pNew; /* Newly allocated page */ int rc; /* Return Code */ Pgno pgnoNew; /* Page number of pNew */ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pBt->mutex) ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pParent->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->nOverflow==1 ); if( pPage->nCell==0 ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; /* dbfuzz001.test */ /* Allocate a new page. This page will become the right-sibling of ** pPage. Make the parent page writable, so that the new divider cell ** may be inserted. If both these operations are successful, proceed. */ rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pNew, &pgnoNew, 0, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ u8 *pOut = &pSpace[4]; u8 *pCell = pPage->apOvfl[0]; u16 szCell = pPage->xCellSize(pPage, pCell); u8 *pStop; assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pNew->pDbPage) ); assert( pPage->aData[0]==(PTF_INTKEY|PTF_LEAFDATA|PTF_LEAF) ); zeroPage(pNew, PTF_INTKEY|PTF_LEAFDATA|PTF_LEAF); rc = rebuildPage(pNew, 1, &pCell, &szCell); if( NEVER(rc) ) return rc; pNew->nFree = pBt->usableSize - pNew->cellOffset - 2 - szCell; /* If this is an auto-vacuum database, update the pointer map ** with entries for the new page, and any pointer from the ** cell on the page to an overflow page. If either of these ** operations fails, the return code is set, but the contents ** of the parent page are still manipulated by thh code below. ** That is Ok, at this point the parent page is guaranteed to ** be marked as dirty. Returning an error code will cause a ** rollback, undoing any changes made to the parent page. */ if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, pgnoNew, PTRMAP_BTREE, pParent->pgno, &rc); if( szCell>pNew->minLocal ){ ptrmapPutOvflPtr(pNew, pCell, &rc); } } /* Create a divider cell to insert into pParent. The divider cell ** consists of a 4-byte page number (the page number of pPage) and ** a variable length key value (which must be the same value as the ** largest key on pPage). ** ** To find the largest key value on pPage, first find the right-most ** cell on pPage. The first two fields of this cell are the ** record-length (a variable length integer at most 32-bits in size) ** and the key value (a variable length integer, may have any value). ** The first of the while(...) loops below skips over the record-length ** field. The second while(...) loop copies the key value from the ** cell on pPage into the pSpace buffer. */ pCell = findCell(pPage, pPage->nCell-1); pStop = &pCell[9]; while( (*(pCell++)&0x80) && pCellnCell, pSpace, (int)(pOut-pSpace), 0, pPage->pgno, &rc); } /* Set the right-child pointer of pParent to point to the new page. */ put4byte(&pParent->aData[pParent->hdrOffset+8], pgnoNew); /* Release the reference to the new page. */ releasePage(pNew); } return rc; } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_QUICKBALANCE */ #if 0 /* ** This function does not contribute anything to the operation of SQLite. ** it is sometimes activated temporarily while debugging code responsible ** for setting pointer-map entries. */ static int ptrmapCheckPages(MemPage **apPage, int nPage){ int i, j; for(i=0; ipBt; assert( pPage->isInit ); for(j=0; jnCell; j++){ CellInfo info; u8 *z; z = findCell(pPage, j); pPage->xParseCell(pPage, z, &info); if( info.nLocalpgno && e==PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1 ); } if( !pPage->leaf ){ Pgno child = get4byte(z); ptrmapGet(pBt, child, &e, &n); assert( n==pPage->pgno && e==PTRMAP_BTREE ); } } if( !pPage->leaf ){ Pgno child = get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8]); ptrmapGet(pBt, child, &e, &n); assert( n==pPage->pgno && e==PTRMAP_BTREE ); } } return 1; } #endif /* ** This function is used to copy the contents of the b-tree node stored ** on page pFrom to page pTo. If page pFrom was not a leaf page, then ** the pointer-map entries for each child page are updated so that the ** parent page stored in the pointer map is page pTo. If pFrom contained ** any cells with overflow page pointers, then the corresponding pointer ** map entries are also updated so that the parent page is page pTo. ** ** If pFrom is currently carrying any overflow cells (entries in the ** MemPage.apOvfl[] array), they are not copied to pTo. ** ** Before returning, page pTo is reinitialized using btreeInitPage(). ** ** The performance of this function is not critical. It is only used by ** the balance_shallower() and balance_deeper() procedures, neither of ** which are called often under normal circumstances. */ static void copyNodeContent(MemPage *pFrom, MemPage *pTo, int *pRC){ if( (*pRC)==SQLITE_OK ){ BtShared * const pBt = pFrom->pBt; u8 * const aFrom = pFrom->aData; u8 * const aTo = pTo->aData; int const iFromHdr = pFrom->hdrOffset; int const iToHdr = ((pTo->pgno==1) ? 100 : 0); int rc; int iData; assert( pFrom->isInit ); assert( pFrom->nFree>=iToHdr ); assert( get2byte(&aFrom[iFromHdr+5]) <= (int)pBt->usableSize ); /* Copy the b-tree node content from page pFrom to page pTo. */ iData = get2byte(&aFrom[iFromHdr+5]); memcpy(&aTo[iData], &aFrom[iData], pBt->usableSize-iData); memcpy(&aTo[iToHdr], &aFrom[iFromHdr], pFrom->cellOffset + 2*pFrom->nCell); /* Reinitialize page pTo so that the contents of the MemPage structure ** match the new data. The initialization of pTo can actually fail under ** fairly obscure circumstances, even though it is a copy of initialized ** page pFrom. */ pTo->isInit = 0; rc = btreeInitPage(pTo); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ *pRC = rc; return; } /* If this is an auto-vacuum database, update the pointer-map entries ** for any b-tree or overflow pages that pTo now contains the pointers to. */ if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ *pRC = setChildPtrmaps(pTo); } } } /* ** This routine redistributes cells on the iParentIdx'th child of pParent ** (hereafter "the page") and up to 2 siblings so that all pages have about the ** same amount of free space. Usually a single sibling on either side of the ** page are used in the balancing, though both siblings might come from one ** side if the page is the first or last child of its parent. If the page ** has fewer than 2 siblings (something which can only happen if the page ** is a root page or a child of a root page) then all available siblings ** participate in the balancing. ** ** The number of siblings of the page might be increased or decreased by ** one or two in an effort to keep pages nearly full but not over full. ** ** Note that when this routine is called, some of the cells on the page ** might not actually be stored in MemPage.aData[]. This can happen ** if the page is overfull. This routine ensures that all cells allocated ** to the page and its siblings fit into MemPage.aData[] before returning. ** ** In the course of balancing the page and its siblings, cells may be ** inserted into or removed from the parent page (pParent). Doing so ** may cause the parent page to become overfull or underfull. If this ** happens, it is the responsibility of the caller to invoke the correct ** balancing routine to fix this problem (see the balance() routine). ** ** If this routine fails for any reason, it might leave the database ** in a corrupted state. So if this routine fails, the database should ** be rolled back. ** ** The third argument to this function, aOvflSpace, is a pointer to a ** buffer big enough to hold one page. If while inserting cells into the parent ** page (pParent) the parent page becomes overfull, this buffer is ** used to store the parent's overflow cells. Because this function inserts ** a maximum of four divider cells into the parent page, and the maximum ** size of a cell stored within an internal node is always less than 1/4 ** of the page-size, the aOvflSpace[] buffer is guaranteed to be large ** enough for all overflow cells. ** ** If aOvflSpace is set to a null pointer, this function returns ** SQLITE_NOMEM. */ static int balance_nonroot( MemPage *pParent, /* Parent page of siblings being balanced */ int iParentIdx, /* Index of "the page" in pParent */ u8 *aOvflSpace, /* page-size bytes of space for parent ovfl */ int isRoot, /* True if pParent is a root-page */ int bBulk /* True if this call is part of a bulk load */ ){ BtShared *pBt; /* The whole database */ int nMaxCells = 0; /* Allocated size of apCell, szCell, aFrom. */ int nNew = 0; /* Number of pages in apNew[] */ int nOld; /* Number of pages in apOld[] */ int i, j, k; /* Loop counters */ int nxDiv; /* Next divider slot in pParent->aCell[] */ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* The return code */ u16 leafCorrection; /* 4 if pPage is a leaf. 0 if not */ int leafData; /* True if pPage is a leaf of a LEAFDATA tree */ int usableSpace; /* Bytes in pPage beyond the header */ int pageFlags; /* Value of pPage->aData[0] */ int iSpace1 = 0; /* First unused byte of aSpace1[] */ int iOvflSpace = 0; /* First unused byte of aOvflSpace[] */ int szScratch; /* Size of scratch memory requested */ MemPage *apOld[NB]; /* pPage and up to two siblings */ MemPage *apNew[NB+2]; /* pPage and up to NB siblings after balancing */ u8 *pRight; /* Location in parent of right-sibling pointer */ u8 *apDiv[NB-1]; /* Divider cells in pParent */ int cntNew[NB+2]; /* Index in b.paCell[] of cell after i-th page */ int cntOld[NB+2]; /* Old index in b.apCell[] */ int szNew[NB+2]; /* Combined size of cells placed on i-th page */ u8 *aSpace1; /* Space for copies of dividers cells */ Pgno pgno; /* Temp var to store a page number in */ u8 abDone[NB+2]; /* True after i'th new page is populated */ Pgno aPgno[NB+2]; /* Page numbers of new pages before shuffling */ Pgno aPgOrder[NB+2]; /* Copy of aPgno[] used for sorting pages */ u16 aPgFlags[NB+2]; /* flags field of new pages before shuffling */ CellArray b; /* Parsed information on cells being balanced */ memset(abDone, 0, sizeof(abDone)); b.nCell = 0; b.apCell = 0; pBt = pParent->pBt; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pParent->pDbPage) ); #if 0 TRACE(("BALANCE: begin page %d child of %d\n", pPage->pgno, pParent->pgno)); #endif /* At this point pParent may have at most one overflow cell. And if ** this overflow cell is present, it must be the cell with ** index iParentIdx. This scenario comes about when this function ** is called (indirectly) from sqlite3BtreeDelete(). */ assert( pParent->nOverflow==0 || pParent->nOverflow==1 ); assert( pParent->nOverflow==0 || pParent->aiOvfl[0]==iParentIdx ); if( !aOvflSpace ){ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; } /* Find the sibling pages to balance. Also locate the cells in pParent ** that divide the siblings. An attempt is made to find NN siblings on ** either side of pPage. More siblings are taken from one side, however, ** if there are fewer than NN siblings on the other side. If pParent ** has NB or fewer children then all children of pParent are taken. ** ** This loop also drops the divider cells from the parent page. This ** way, the remainder of the function does not have to deal with any ** overflow cells in the parent page, since if any existed they will ** have already been removed. */ i = pParent->nOverflow + pParent->nCell; if( i<2 ){ nxDiv = 0; }else{ assert( bBulk==0 || bBulk==1 ); if( iParentIdx==0 ){ nxDiv = 0; }else if( iParentIdx==i ){ nxDiv = i-2+bBulk; }else{ nxDiv = iParentIdx-1; } i = 2-bBulk; } nOld = i+1; if( (i+nxDiv-pParent->nOverflow)==pParent->nCell ){ pRight = &pParent->aData[pParent->hdrOffset+8]; }else{ pRight = findCell(pParent, i+nxDiv-pParent->nOverflow); } pgno = get4byte(pRight); while( 1 ){ rc = getAndInitPage(pBt, pgno, &apOld[i], 0, 0); if( rc ){ memset(apOld, 0, (i+1)*sizeof(MemPage*)); goto balance_cleanup; } nMaxCells += 1+apOld[i]->nCell+apOld[i]->nOverflow; if( (i--)==0 ) break; if( pParent->nOverflow && i+nxDiv==pParent->aiOvfl[0] ){ apDiv[i] = pParent->apOvfl[0]; pgno = get4byte(apDiv[i]); szNew[i] = pParent->xCellSize(pParent, apDiv[i]); pParent->nOverflow = 0; }else{ apDiv[i] = findCell(pParent, i+nxDiv-pParent->nOverflow); pgno = get4byte(apDiv[i]); szNew[i] = pParent->xCellSize(pParent, apDiv[i]); /* Drop the cell from the parent page. apDiv[i] still points to ** the cell within the parent, even though it has been dropped. ** This is safe because dropping a cell only overwrites the first ** four bytes of it, and this function does not need the first ** four bytes of the divider cell. So the pointer is safe to use ** later on. ** ** But not if we are in secure-delete mode. In secure-delete mode, ** the dropCell() routine will overwrite the entire cell with zeroes. ** In this case, temporarily copy the cell into the aOvflSpace[] ** buffer. It will be copied out again as soon as the aSpace[] buffer ** is allocated. */ if( pBt->btsFlags & BTS_FAST_SECURE ){ int iOff; iOff = SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(apDiv[i]) - SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(pParent->aData); if( (iOff+szNew[i])>(int)pBt->usableSize ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; memset(apOld, 0, (i+1)*sizeof(MemPage*)); goto balance_cleanup; }else{ memcpy(&aOvflSpace[iOff], apDiv[i], szNew[i]); apDiv[i] = &aOvflSpace[apDiv[i]-pParent->aData]; } } dropCell(pParent, i+nxDiv-pParent->nOverflow, szNew[i], &rc); } } /* Make nMaxCells a multiple of 4 in order to preserve 8-byte ** alignment */ nMaxCells = (nMaxCells + 3)&~3; /* ** Allocate space for memory structures */ szScratch = nMaxCells*sizeof(u8*) /* b.apCell */ + nMaxCells*sizeof(u16) /* b.szCell */ + pBt->pageSize; /* aSpace1 */ assert( szScratch<=6*(int)pBt->pageSize ); b.apCell = sqlite3StackAllocRaw(0, szScratch ); if( b.apCell==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT; goto balance_cleanup; } b.szCell = (u16*)&b.apCell[nMaxCells]; aSpace1 = (u8*)&b.szCell[nMaxCells]; assert( EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(aSpace1) ); /* ** Load pointers to all cells on sibling pages and the divider cells ** into the local b.apCell[] array. Make copies of the divider cells ** into space obtained from aSpace1[]. The divider cells have already ** been removed from pParent. ** ** If the siblings are on leaf pages, then the child pointers of the ** divider cells are stripped from the cells before they are copied ** into aSpace1[]. In this way, all cells in b.apCell[] are without ** child pointers. If siblings are not leaves, then all cell in ** b.apCell[] include child pointers. Either way, all cells in b.apCell[] ** are alike. ** ** leafCorrection: 4 if pPage is a leaf. 0 if pPage is not a leaf. ** leafData: 1 if pPage holds key+data and pParent holds only keys. */ b.pRef = apOld[0]; leafCorrection = b.pRef->leaf*4; leafData = b.pRef->intKeyLeaf; for(i=0; inCell; u8 *aData = pOld->aData; u16 maskPage = pOld->maskPage; u8 *piCell = aData + pOld->cellOffset; u8 *piEnd; /* Verify that all sibling pages are of the same "type" (table-leaf, ** table-interior, index-leaf, or index-interior). */ if( pOld->aData[0]!=apOld[0]->aData[0] ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto balance_cleanup; } /* Load b.apCell[] with pointers to all cells in pOld. If pOld ** contains overflow cells, include them in the b.apCell[] array ** in the correct spot. ** ** Note that when there are multiple overflow cells, it is always the ** case that they are sequential and adjacent. This invariant arises ** because multiple overflows can only occurs when inserting divider ** cells into a parent on a prior balance, and divider cells are always ** adjacent and are inserted in order. There is an assert() tagged ** with "NOTE 1" in the overflow cell insertion loop to prove this ** invariant. ** ** This must be done in advance. Once the balance starts, the cell ** offset section of the btree page will be overwritten and we will no ** long be able to find the cells if a pointer to each cell is not saved ** first. */ memset(&b.szCell[b.nCell], 0, sizeof(b.szCell[0])*(limit+pOld->nOverflow)); if( pOld->nOverflow>0 ){ limit = pOld->aiOvfl[0]; for(j=0; jnOverflow; k++){ assert( k==0 || pOld->aiOvfl[k-1]+1==pOld->aiOvfl[k] );/* NOTE 1 */ b.apCell[b.nCell] = pOld->apOvfl[k]; b.nCell++; } } piEnd = aData + pOld->cellOffset + 2*pOld->nCell; while( piCellmaxLocal+23 ); assert( iSpace1 <= (int)pBt->pageSize ); memcpy(pTemp, apDiv[i], sz); b.apCell[b.nCell] = pTemp+leafCorrection; assert( leafCorrection==0 || leafCorrection==4 ); b.szCell[b.nCell] = b.szCell[b.nCell] - leafCorrection; if( !pOld->leaf ){ assert( leafCorrection==0 ); assert( pOld->hdrOffset==0 ); /* The right pointer of the child page pOld becomes the left ** pointer of the divider cell */ memcpy(b.apCell[b.nCell], &pOld->aData[8], 4); }else{ assert( leafCorrection==4 ); while( b.szCell[b.nCell]<4 ){ /* Do not allow any cells smaller than 4 bytes. If a smaller cell ** does exist, pad it with 0x00 bytes. */ assert( b.szCell[b.nCell]==3 || CORRUPT_DB ); assert( b.apCell[b.nCell]==&aSpace1[iSpace1-3] || CORRUPT_DB ); aSpace1[iSpace1++] = 0x00; b.szCell[b.nCell]++; } } b.nCell++; } } /* ** Figure out the number of pages needed to hold all b.nCell cells. ** Store this number in "k". Also compute szNew[] which is the total ** size of all cells on the i-th page and cntNew[] which is the index ** in b.apCell[] of the cell that divides page i from page i+1. ** cntNew[k] should equal b.nCell. ** ** Values computed by this block: ** ** k: The total number of sibling pages ** szNew[i]: Spaced used on the i-th sibling page. ** cntNew[i]: Index in b.apCell[] and b.szCell[] for the first cell to ** the right of the i-th sibling page. ** usableSpace: Number of bytes of space available on each sibling. ** */ usableSpace = pBt->usableSize - 12 + leafCorrection; for(i=0; inFree; for(j=0; jnOverflow; j++){ szNew[i] += 2 + p->xCellSize(p, p->apOvfl[j]); } cntNew[i] = cntOld[i]; } k = nOld; for(i=0; iusableSpace ){ if( i+1>=k ){ k = i+2; if( k>NB+2 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto balance_cleanup; } szNew[k-1] = 0; cntNew[k-1] = b.nCell; } sz = 2 + cachedCellSize(&b, cntNew[i]-1); szNew[i] -= sz; if( !leafData ){ if( cntNew[i]usableSpace ) break; szNew[i] += sz; cntNew[i]++; if( !leafData ){ if( cntNew[i]=b.nCell ){ k = i+1; }else if( cntNew[i] <= (i>0 ? cntNew[i-1] : 0) ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto balance_cleanup; } } /* ** The packing computed by the previous block is biased toward the siblings ** on the left side (siblings with smaller keys). The left siblings are ** always nearly full, while the right-most sibling might be nearly empty. ** The next block of code attempts to adjust the packing of siblings to ** get a better balance. ** ** This adjustment is more than an optimization. The packing above might ** be so out of balance as to be illegal. For example, the right-most ** sibling might be completely empty. This adjustment is not optional. */ for(i=k-1; i>0; i--){ int szRight = szNew[i]; /* Size of sibling on the right */ int szLeft = szNew[i-1]; /* Size of sibling on the left */ int r; /* Index of right-most cell in left sibling */ int d; /* Index of first cell to the left of right sibling */ r = cntNew[i-1] - 1; d = r + 1 - leafData; (void)cachedCellSize(&b, d); do{ assert( d szLeft-(b.szCell[r]+(i==k-1?0:2)))){ break; } szRight += b.szCell[d] + 2; szLeft -= b.szCell[r] + 2; cntNew[i-1] = r; r--; d--; }while( r>=0 ); szNew[i] = szRight; szNew[i-1] = szLeft; if( cntNew[i-1] <= (i>1 ? cntNew[i-2] : 0) ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto balance_cleanup; } } /* Sanity check: For a non-corrupt database file one of the follwing ** must be true: ** (1) We found one or more cells (cntNew[0])>0), or ** (2) pPage is a virtual root page. A virtual root page is when ** the real root page is page 1 and we are the only child of ** that page. */ assert( cntNew[0]>0 || (pParent->pgno==1 && pParent->nCell==0) || CORRUPT_DB); TRACE(("BALANCE: old: %d(nc=%d) %d(nc=%d) %d(nc=%d)\n", apOld[0]->pgno, apOld[0]->nCell, nOld>=2 ? apOld[1]->pgno : 0, nOld>=2 ? apOld[1]->nCell : 0, nOld>=3 ? apOld[2]->pgno : 0, nOld>=3 ? apOld[2]->nCell : 0 )); /* ** Allocate k new pages. Reuse old pages where possible. */ pageFlags = apOld[0]->aData[0]; for(i=0; ipDbPage); nNew++; if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup; }else{ assert( i>0 ); rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pNew, &pgno, (bBulk ? 1 : pgno), 0); if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup; zeroPage(pNew, pageFlags); apNew[i] = pNew; nNew++; cntOld[i] = b.nCell; /* Set the pointer-map entry for the new sibling page. */ if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, pNew->pgno, PTRMAP_BTREE, pParent->pgno, &rc); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ goto balance_cleanup; } } } } /* ** Reassign page numbers so that the new pages are in ascending order. ** This helps to keep entries in the disk file in order so that a scan ** of the table is closer to a linear scan through the file. That in turn ** helps the operating system to deliver pages from the disk more rapidly. ** ** An O(n^2) insertion sort algorithm is used, but since n is never more ** than (NB+2) (a small constant), that should not be a problem. ** ** When NB==3, this one optimization makes the database about 25% faster ** for large insertions and deletions. */ for(i=0; ipgno; aPgFlags[i] = apNew[i]->pDbPage->flags; for(j=0; ji ){ sqlite3PagerRekey(apNew[iBest]->pDbPage, pBt->nPage+iBest+1, 0); } sqlite3PagerRekey(apNew[i]->pDbPage, pgno, aPgFlags[iBest]); apNew[i]->pgno = pgno; } } TRACE(("BALANCE: new: %d(%d nc=%d) %d(%d nc=%d) %d(%d nc=%d) " "%d(%d nc=%d) %d(%d nc=%d)\n", apNew[0]->pgno, szNew[0], cntNew[0], nNew>=2 ? apNew[1]->pgno : 0, nNew>=2 ? szNew[1] : 0, nNew>=2 ? cntNew[1] - cntNew[0] - !leafData : 0, nNew>=3 ? apNew[2]->pgno : 0, nNew>=3 ? szNew[2] : 0, nNew>=3 ? cntNew[2] - cntNew[1] - !leafData : 0, nNew>=4 ? apNew[3]->pgno : 0, nNew>=4 ? szNew[3] : 0, nNew>=4 ? cntNew[3] - cntNew[2] - !leafData : 0, nNew>=5 ? apNew[4]->pgno : 0, nNew>=5 ? szNew[4] : 0, nNew>=5 ? cntNew[4] - cntNew[3] - !leafData : 0 )); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pParent->pDbPage) ); put4byte(pRight, apNew[nNew-1]->pgno); /* If the sibling pages are not leaves, ensure that the right-child pointer ** of the right-most new sibling page is set to the value that was ** originally in the same field of the right-most old sibling page. */ if( (pageFlags & PTF_LEAF)==0 && nOld!=nNew ){ MemPage *pOld = (nNew>nOld ? apNew : apOld)[nOld-1]; memcpy(&apNew[nNew-1]->aData[8], &pOld->aData[8], 4); } /* Make any required updates to pointer map entries associated with ** cells stored on sibling pages following the balance operation. Pointer ** map entries associated with divider cells are set by the insertCell() ** routine. The associated pointer map entries are: ** ** a) if the cell contains a reference to an overflow chain, the ** entry associated with the first page in the overflow chain, and ** ** b) if the sibling pages are not leaves, the child page associated ** with the cell. ** ** If the sibling pages are not leaves, then the pointer map entry ** associated with the right-child of each sibling may also need to be ** updated. This happens below, after the sibling pages have been ** populated, not here. */ if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ MemPage *pNew = apNew[0]; u8 *aOld = pNew->aData; int cntOldNext = pNew->nCell + pNew->nOverflow; int usableSize = pBt->usableSize; int iNew = 0; int iOld = 0; for(i=0; inCell + pOld->nOverflow + !leafData; aOld = pOld->aData; } if( i==cntNew[iNew] ){ pNew = apNew[++iNew]; if( !leafData ) continue; } /* Cell pCell is destined for new sibling page pNew. Originally, it ** was either part of sibling page iOld (possibly an overflow cell), ** or else the divider cell to the left of sibling page iOld. So, ** if sibling page iOld had the same page number as pNew, and if ** pCell really was a part of sibling page iOld (not a divider or ** overflow cell), we can skip updating the pointer map entries. */ if( iOld>=nNew || pNew->pgno!=aPgno[iOld] || !SQLITE_WITHIN(pCell,aOld,&aOld[usableSize]) ){ if( !leafCorrection ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, get4byte(pCell), PTRMAP_BTREE, pNew->pgno, &rc); } if( cachedCellSize(&b,i)>pNew->minLocal ){ ptrmapPutOvflPtr(pNew, pCell, &rc); } if( rc ) goto balance_cleanup; } } } /* Insert new divider cells into pParent. */ for(i=0; ileaf ){ memcpy(&pNew->aData[8], pCell, 4); }else if( leafData ){ /* If the tree is a leaf-data tree, and the siblings are leaves, ** then there is no divider cell in b.apCell[]. Instead, the divider ** cell consists of the integer key for the right-most cell of ** the sibling-page assembled above only. */ CellInfo info; j--; pNew->xParseCell(pNew, b.apCell[j], &info); pCell = pTemp; sz = 4 + putVarint(&pCell[4], info.nKey); pTemp = 0; }else{ pCell -= 4; /* Obscure case for non-leaf-data trees: If the cell at pCell was ** previously stored on a leaf node, and its reported size was 4 ** bytes, then it may actually be smaller than this ** (see btreeParseCellPtr(), 4 bytes is the minimum size of ** any cell). But it is important to pass the correct size to ** insertCell(), so reparse the cell now. ** ** This can only happen for b-trees used to evaluate "IN (SELECT ...)" ** and WITHOUT ROWID tables with exactly one column which is the ** primary key. */ if( b.szCell[j]==4 ){ assert(leafCorrection==4); sz = pParent->xCellSize(pParent, pCell); } } iOvflSpace += sz; assert( sz<=pBt->maxLocal+23 ); assert( iOvflSpace <= (int)pBt->pageSize ); insertCell(pParent, nxDiv+i, pCell, sz, pTemp, pNew->pgno, &rc); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto balance_cleanup; assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pParent->pDbPage) ); } /* Now update the actual sibling pages. The order in which they are updated ** is important, as this code needs to avoid disrupting any page from which ** cells may still to be read. In practice, this means: ** ** (1) If cells are moving left (from apNew[iPg] to apNew[iPg-1]) ** then it is not safe to update page apNew[iPg] until after ** the left-hand sibling apNew[iPg-1] has been updated. ** ** (2) If cells are moving right (from apNew[iPg] to apNew[iPg+1]) ** then it is not safe to update page apNew[iPg] until after ** the right-hand sibling apNew[iPg+1] has been updated. ** ** If neither of the above apply, the page is safe to update. ** ** The iPg value in the following loop starts at nNew-1 goes down ** to 0, then back up to nNew-1 again, thus making two passes over ** the pages. On the initial downward pass, only condition (1) above ** needs to be tested because (2) will always be true from the previous ** step. On the upward pass, both conditions are always true, so the ** upwards pass simply processes pages that were missed on the downward ** pass. */ for(i=1-nNew; i=0 && iPg=0 /* On the upwards pass, or... */ || cntOld[iPg-1]>=cntNew[iPg-1] /* Condition (1) is true */ ){ int iNew; int iOld; int nNewCell; /* Verify condition (1): If cells are moving left, update iPg ** only after iPg-1 has already been updated. */ assert( iPg==0 || cntOld[iPg-1]>=cntNew[iPg-1] || abDone[iPg-1] ); /* Verify condition (2): If cells are moving right, update iPg ** only after iPg+1 has already been updated. */ assert( cntNew[iPg]>=cntOld[iPg] || abDone[iPg+1] ); if( iPg==0 ){ iNew = iOld = 0; nNewCell = cntNew[0]; }else{ iOld = iPgnFree = usableSpace-szNew[iPg]; assert( apNew[iPg]->nOverflow==0 ); assert( apNew[iPg]->nCell==nNewCell ); } } /* All pages have been processed exactly once */ assert( memcmp(abDone, "\01\01\01\01\01", nNew)==0 ); assert( nOld>0 ); assert( nNew>0 ); if( isRoot && pParent->nCell==0 && pParent->hdrOffset<=apNew[0]->nFree ){ /* The root page of the b-tree now contains no cells. The only sibling ** page is the right-child of the parent. Copy the contents of the ** child page into the parent, decreasing the overall height of the ** b-tree structure by one. This is described as the "balance-shallower" ** sub-algorithm in some documentation. ** ** If this is an auto-vacuum database, the call to copyNodeContent() ** sets all pointer-map entries corresponding to database image pages ** for which the pointer is stored within the content being copied. ** ** It is critical that the child page be defragmented before being ** copied into the parent, because if the parent is page 1 then it will ** by smaller than the child due to the database header, and so all the ** free space needs to be up front. */ assert( nNew==1 || CORRUPT_DB ); rc = defragmentPage(apNew[0], -1); testcase( rc!=SQLITE_OK ); assert( apNew[0]->nFree == (get2byte(&apNew[0]->aData[5])-apNew[0]->cellOffset-apNew[0]->nCell*2) || rc!=SQLITE_OK ); copyNodeContent(apNew[0], pParent, &rc); freePage(apNew[0], &rc); }else if( ISAUTOVACUUM && !leafCorrection ){ /* Fix the pointer map entries associated with the right-child of each ** sibling page. All other pointer map entries have already been taken ** care of. */ for(i=0; iaData[8]); ptrmapPut(pBt, key, PTRMAP_BTREE, apNew[i]->pgno, &rc); } } assert( pParent->isInit ); TRACE(("BALANCE: finished: old=%d new=%d cells=%d\n", nOld, nNew, b.nCell)); /* Free any old pages that were not reused as new pages. */ for(i=nNew; iisInit ){ /* The ptrmapCheckPages() contains assert() statements that verify that ** all pointer map pages are set correctly. This is helpful while ** debugging. This is usually disabled because a corrupt database may ** cause an assert() statement to fail. */ ptrmapCheckPages(apNew, nNew); ptrmapCheckPages(&pParent, 1); } #endif /* ** Cleanup before returning. */ balance_cleanup: sqlite3StackFree(0, b.apCell); for(i=0; ipBt; /* The BTree */ assert( pRoot->nOverflow>0 ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); /* Make pRoot, the root page of the b-tree, writable. Allocate a new ** page that will become the new right-child of pPage. Copy the contents ** of the node stored on pRoot into the new child page. */ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pRoot->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt,&pChild,&pgnoChild,pRoot->pgno,0); copyNodeContent(pRoot, pChild, &rc); if( ISAUTOVACUUM ){ ptrmapPut(pBt, pgnoChild, PTRMAP_BTREE, pRoot->pgno, &rc); } } if( rc ){ *ppChild = 0; releasePage(pChild); return rc; } assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pChild->pDbPage) ); assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pRoot->pDbPage) ); assert( pChild->nCell==pRoot->nCell ); TRACE(("BALANCE: copy root %d into %d\n", pRoot->pgno, pChild->pgno)); /* Copy the overflow cells from pRoot to pChild */ memcpy(pChild->aiOvfl, pRoot->aiOvfl, pRoot->nOverflow*sizeof(pRoot->aiOvfl[0])); memcpy(pChild->apOvfl, pRoot->apOvfl, pRoot->nOverflow*sizeof(pRoot->apOvfl[0])); pChild->nOverflow = pRoot->nOverflow; /* Zero the contents of pRoot. Then install pChild as the right-child. */ zeroPage(pRoot, pChild->aData[0] & ~PTF_LEAF); put4byte(&pRoot->aData[pRoot->hdrOffset+8], pgnoChild); *ppChild = pChild; return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** The page that pCur currently points to has just been modified in ** some way. This function figures out if this modification means the ** tree needs to be balanced, and if so calls the appropriate balancing ** routine. Balancing routines are: ** ** balance_quick() ** balance_deeper() ** balance_nonroot() */ static int balance(BtCursor *pCur){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; const int nMin = pCur->pBt->usableSize * 2 / 3; u8 aBalanceQuickSpace[13]; u8 *pFree = 0; VVA_ONLY( int balance_quick_called = 0 ); VVA_ONLY( int balance_deeper_called = 0 ); do { int iPage = pCur->iPage; MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage; if( iPage==0 ){ if( pPage->nOverflow ){ /* The root page of the b-tree is overfull. In this case call the ** balance_deeper() function to create a new child for the root-page ** and copy the current contents of the root-page to it. The ** next iteration of the do-loop will balance the child page. */ assert( balance_deeper_called==0 ); VVA_ONLY( balance_deeper_called++ ); rc = balance_deeper(pPage, &pCur->apPage[1]); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ pCur->iPage = 1; pCur->ix = 0; pCur->aiIdx[0] = 0; pCur->apPage[0] = pPage; pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[1]; assert( pCur->pPage->nOverflow ); } }else{ break; } }else if( pPage->nOverflow==0 && pPage->nFree<=nMin ){ break; }else{ MemPage * const pParent = pCur->apPage[iPage-1]; int const iIdx = pCur->aiIdx[iPage-1]; rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pParent->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_QUICKBALANCE if( pPage->intKeyLeaf && pPage->nOverflow==1 && pPage->aiOvfl[0]==pPage->nCell && pParent->pgno!=1 && pParent->nCell==iIdx ){ /* Call balance_quick() to create a new sibling of pPage on which ** to store the overflow cell. balance_quick() inserts a new cell ** into pParent, which may cause pParent overflow. If this ** happens, the next iteration of the do-loop will balance pParent ** use either balance_nonroot() or balance_deeper(). Until this ** happens, the overflow cell is stored in the aBalanceQuickSpace[] ** buffer. ** ** The purpose of the following assert() is to check that only a ** single call to balance_quick() is made for each call to this ** function. If this were not verified, a subtle bug involving reuse ** of the aBalanceQuickSpace[] might sneak in. */ assert( balance_quick_called==0 ); VVA_ONLY( balance_quick_called++ ); rc = balance_quick(pParent, pPage, aBalanceQuickSpace); }else #endif { /* In this case, call balance_nonroot() to redistribute cells ** between pPage and up to 2 of its sibling pages. This involves ** modifying the contents of pParent, which may cause pParent to ** become overfull or underfull. The next iteration of the do-loop ** will balance the parent page to correct this. ** ** If the parent page becomes overfull, the overflow cell or cells ** are stored in the pSpace buffer allocated immediately below. ** A subsequent iteration of the do-loop will deal with this by ** calling balance_nonroot() (balance_deeper() may be called first, ** but it doesn't deal with overflow cells - just moves them to a ** different page). Once this subsequent call to balance_nonroot() ** has completed, it is safe to release the pSpace buffer used by ** the previous call, as the overflow cell data will have been ** copied either into the body of a database page or into the new ** pSpace buffer passed to the latter call to balance_nonroot(). */ u8 *pSpace = sqlite3PageMalloc(pCur->pBt->pageSize); rc = balance_nonroot(pParent, iIdx, pSpace, iPage==1, pCur->hints&BTREE_BULKLOAD); if( pFree ){ /* If pFree is not NULL, it points to the pSpace buffer used ** by a previous call to balance_nonroot(). Its contents are ** now stored either on real database pages or within the ** new pSpace buffer, so it may be safely freed here. */ sqlite3PageFree(pFree); } /* The pSpace buffer will be freed after the next call to ** balance_nonroot(), or just before this function returns, whichever ** comes first. */ pFree = pSpace; } } pPage->nOverflow = 0; /* The next iteration of the do-loop balances the parent page. */ releasePage(pPage); pCur->iPage--; assert( pCur->iPage>=0 ); pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage]; } }while( rc==SQLITE_OK ); if( pFree ){ sqlite3PageFree(pFree); } return rc; } /* Overwrite content from pX into pDest. Only do the write if the ** content is different from what is already there. */ static int btreeOverwriteContent( MemPage *pPage, /* MemPage on which writing will occur */ u8 *pDest, /* Pointer to the place to start writing */ const BtreePayload *pX, /* Source of data to write */ int iOffset, /* Offset of first byte to write */ int iAmt /* Number of bytes to be written */ ){ int nData = pX->nData - iOffset; if( nData<=0 ){ /* Overwritting with zeros */ int i; for(i=0; ipDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; memset(pDest + i, 0, iAmt - i); } }else{ if( nDatapData) + iOffset, iAmt)!=0 ){ int rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; memcpy(pDest, ((u8*)pX->pData) + iOffset, iAmt); } } return SQLITE_OK; } /* ** Overwrite the cell that cursor pCur is pointing to with fresh content ** contained in pX. */ static int btreeOverwriteCell(BtCursor *pCur, const BtreePayload *pX){ int iOffset; /* Next byte of pX->pData to write */ int nTotal = pX->nData + pX->nZero; /* Total bytes of to write */ int rc; /* Return code */ MemPage *pPage = pCur->pPage; /* Page being written */ BtShared *pBt; /* Btree */ Pgno ovflPgno; /* Next overflow page to write */ u32 ovflPageSize; /* Size to write on overflow page */ if( pCur->info.pPayload + pCur->info.nLocal > pPage->aDataEnd ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } /* Overwrite the local portion first */ rc = btreeOverwriteContent(pPage, pCur->info.pPayload, pX, 0, pCur->info.nLocal); if( rc ) return rc; if( pCur->info.nLocal==nTotal ) return SQLITE_OK; /* Now overwrite the overflow pages */ iOffset = pCur->info.nLocal; assert( nTotal>=0 ); assert( iOffset>=0 ); ovflPgno = get4byte(pCur->info.pPayload + iOffset); pBt = pPage->pBt; ovflPageSize = pBt->usableSize - 4; do{ rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, ovflPgno, &pPage, 0); if( rc ) return rc; if( sqlite3PagerPageRefcount(pPage->pDbPage)!=1 ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; }else{ if( iOffset+ovflPageSize<(u32)nTotal ){ ovflPgno = get4byte(pPage->aData); }else{ ovflPageSize = nTotal - iOffset; } rc = btreeOverwriteContent(pPage, pPage->aData+4, pX, iOffset, ovflPageSize); } sqlite3PagerUnref(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; iOffset += ovflPageSize; }while( iOffset0 then pCur points to a cell ** that is larger than (pKey,nKey). ** ** If seekResult==0, that means pCur is pointing at some unknown location. ** In that case, this routine must seek the cursor to the correct insertion ** point for (pKey,nKey) before doing the insertion. For index btrees, ** if pX->nMem is non-zero, then pX->aMem contains pointers to the unpacked ** key values and pX->aMem can be used instead of pX->pKey to avoid having ** to decode the key. */ int sqlite3BtreeInsert( BtCursor *pCur, /* Insert data into the table of this cursor */ const BtreePayload *pX, /* Content of the row to be inserted */ int flags, /* True if this is likely an append */ int seekResult /* Result of prior MovetoUnpacked() call */ ){ int rc; int loc = seekResult; /* -1: before desired location +1: after */ int szNew = 0; int idx; MemPage *pPage; Btree *p = pCur->pBtree; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; unsigned char *oldCell; unsigned char *newCell = 0; assert( (flags & (BTREE_SAVEPOSITION|BTREE_APPEND))==flags ); if( pCur->eState==CURSOR_FAULT ){ assert( pCur->skipNext!=SQLITE_OK ); return pCur->skipNext; } assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( (pCur->curFlags & BTCF_WriteFlag)!=0 && pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE && (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 ); assert( hasSharedCacheTableLock(p, pCur->pgnoRoot, pCur->pKeyInfo!=0, 2) ); /* Assert that the caller has been consistent. If this cursor was opened ** expecting an index b-tree, then the caller should be inserting blob ** keys with no associated data. If the cursor was opened expecting an ** intkey table, the caller should be inserting integer keys with a ** blob of associated data. */ assert( (pX->pKey==0)==(pCur->pKeyInfo==0) ); /* Save the positions of any other cursors open on this table. ** ** In some cases, the call to btreeMoveto() below is a no-op. For ** example, when inserting data into a table with auto-generated integer ** keys, the VDBE layer invokes sqlite3BtreeLast() to figure out the ** integer key to use. It then calls this function to actually insert the ** data into the intkey B-Tree. In this case btreeMoveto() recognizes ** that the cursor is already where it needs to be and returns without ** doing any work. To avoid thwarting these optimizations, it is important ** not to clear the cursor here. */ if( pCur->curFlags & BTCF_Multiple ){ rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, pCur->pgnoRoot, pCur); if( rc ) return rc; } if( pCur->pKeyInfo==0 ){ assert( pX->pKey==0 ); /* If this is an insert into a table b-tree, invalidate any incrblob ** cursors open on the row being replaced */ invalidateIncrblobCursors(p, pCur->pgnoRoot, pX->nKey, 0); /* If BTREE_SAVEPOSITION is set, the cursor must already be pointing ** to a row with the same key as the new entry being inserted. */ #ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG if( flags & BTREE_SAVEPOSITION ){ assert( pCur->curFlags & BTCF_ValidNKey ); assert( pX->nKey==pCur->info.nKey ); assert( pCur->info.nSize!=0 ); assert( loc==0 ); } #endif /* On the other hand, BTREE_SAVEPOSITION==0 does not imply ** that the cursor is not pointing to a row to be overwritten. ** So do a complete check. */ if( (pCur->curFlags&BTCF_ValidNKey)!=0 && pX->nKey==pCur->info.nKey ){ /* The cursor is pointing to the entry that is to be ** overwritten */ assert( pX->nData>=0 && pX->nZero>=0 ); if( pCur->info.nSize!=0 && pCur->info.nPayload==(u32)pX->nData+pX->nZero ){ /* New entry is the same size as the old. Do an overwrite */ return btreeOverwriteCell(pCur, pX); } assert( loc==0 ); }else if( loc==0 ){ /* The cursor is *not* pointing to the cell to be overwritten, nor ** to an adjacent cell. Move the cursor so that it is pointing either ** to the cell to be overwritten or an adjacent cell. */ rc = sqlite3BtreeMovetoUnpacked(pCur, 0, pX->nKey, flags!=0, &loc); if( rc ) return rc; } }else{ /* This is an index or a WITHOUT ROWID table */ /* If BTREE_SAVEPOSITION is set, the cursor must already be pointing ** to a row with the same key as the new entry being inserted. */ assert( (flags & BTREE_SAVEPOSITION)==0 || loc==0 ); /* If the cursor is not already pointing either to the cell to be ** overwritten, or if a new cell is being inserted, if the cursor is ** not pointing to an immediately adjacent cell, then move the cursor ** so that it does. */ if( loc==0 && (flags & BTREE_SAVEPOSITION)==0 ){ if( pX->nMem ){ UnpackedRecord r; r.pKeyInfo = pCur->pKeyInfo; r.aMem = pX->aMem; r.nField = pX->nMem; r.default_rc = 0; r.errCode = 0; r.r1 = 0; r.r2 = 0; r.eqSeen = 0; rc = sqlite3BtreeMovetoUnpacked(pCur, &r, 0, flags!=0, &loc); }else{ rc = btreeMoveto(pCur, pX->pKey, pX->nKey, flags!=0, &loc); } if( rc ) return rc; } /* If the cursor is currently pointing to an entry to be overwritten ** and the new content is the same as as the old, then use the ** overwrite optimization. */ if( loc==0 ){ getCellInfo(pCur); if( pCur->info.nKey==pX->nKey ){ BtreePayload x2; x2.pData = pX->pKey; x2.nData = pX->nKey; x2.nZero = 0; return btreeOverwriteCell(pCur, &x2); } } } assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID || (pCur->eState==CURSOR_INVALID && loc) ); pPage = pCur->pPage; assert( pPage->intKey || pX->nKey>=0 ); assert( pPage->leaf || !pPage->intKey ); TRACE(("INSERT: table=%d nkey=%lld ndata=%d page=%d %s\n", pCur->pgnoRoot, pX->nKey, pX->nData, pPage->pgno, loc==0 ? "overwrite" : "new entry")); assert( pPage->isInit ); newCell = pBt->pTmpSpace; assert( newCell!=0 ); rc = fillInCell(pPage, newCell, pX, &szNew); if( rc ) goto end_insert; assert( szNew==pPage->xCellSize(pPage, newCell) ); assert( szNew <= MX_CELL_SIZE(pBt) ); idx = pCur->ix; if( loc==0 ){ CellInfo info; assert( idxnCell ); rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc ){ goto end_insert; } oldCell = findCell(pPage, idx); if( !pPage->leaf ){ memcpy(newCell, oldCell, 4); } rc = clearCell(pPage, oldCell, &info); if( info.nSize==szNew && info.nLocal==info.nPayload && (!ISAUTOVACUUM || szNewminLocal) ){ /* Overwrite the old cell with the new if they are the same size. ** We could also try to do this if the old cell is smaller, then add ** the leftover space to the free list. But experiments show that ** doing that is no faster then skipping this optimization and just ** calling dropCell() and insertCell(). ** ** This optimization cannot be used on an autovacuum database if the ** new entry uses overflow pages, as the insertCell() call below is ** necessary to add the PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1 pointer-map entry. */ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK ); /* clearCell never fails when nLocal==nPayload */ if( oldCell+szNew > pPage->aDataEnd ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; memcpy(oldCell, newCell, szNew); return SQLITE_OK; } dropCell(pPage, idx, info.nSize, &rc); if( rc ) goto end_insert; }else if( loc<0 && pPage->nCell>0 ){ assert( pPage->leaf ); idx = ++pCur->ix; pCur->curFlags &= ~BTCF_ValidNKey; }else{ assert( pPage->leaf ); } insertCell(pPage, idx, newCell, szNew, 0, 0, &rc); assert( pPage->nOverflow==0 || rc==SQLITE_OK ); assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || pPage->nCell>0 || pPage->nOverflow>0 ); /* If no error has occurred and pPage has an overflow cell, call balance() ** to redistribute the cells within the tree. Since balance() may move ** the cursor, zero the BtCursor.info.nSize and BTCF_ValidNKey ** variables. ** ** Previous versions of SQLite called moveToRoot() to move the cursor ** back to the root page as balance() used to invalidate the contents ** of BtCursor.apPage[] and BtCursor.aiIdx[]. Instead of doing that, ** set the cursor state to "invalid". This makes common insert operations ** slightly faster. ** ** There is a subtle but important optimization here too. When inserting ** multiple records into an intkey b-tree using a single cursor (as can ** happen while processing an "INSERT INTO ... SELECT" statement), it ** is advantageous to leave the cursor pointing to the last entry in ** the b-tree if possible. If the cursor is left pointing to the last ** entry in the table, and the next row inserted has an integer key ** larger than the largest existing key, it is possible to insert the ** row without seeking the cursor. This can be a big performance boost. */ pCur->info.nSize = 0; if( pPage->nOverflow ){ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK ); pCur->curFlags &= ~(BTCF_ValidNKey); rc = balance(pCur); /* Must make sure nOverflow is reset to zero even if the balance() ** fails. Internal data structure corruption will result otherwise. ** Also, set the cursor state to invalid. This stops saveCursorPosition() ** from trying to save the current position of the cursor. */ pCur->pPage->nOverflow = 0; pCur->eState = CURSOR_INVALID; if( (flags & BTREE_SAVEPOSITION) && rc==SQLITE_OK ){ btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(pCur); if( pCur->pKeyInfo ){ assert( pCur->pKey==0 ); pCur->pKey = sqlite3Malloc( pX->nKey ); if( pCur->pKey==0 ){ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM; }else{ memcpy(pCur->pKey, pX->pKey, pX->nKey); } } pCur->eState = CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK; pCur->nKey = pX->nKey; } } assert( pCur->iPage<0 || pCur->pPage->nOverflow==0 ); end_insert: return rc; } /* ** Delete the entry that the cursor is pointing to. ** ** If the BTREE_SAVEPOSITION bit of the flags parameter is zero, then ** the cursor is left pointing at an arbitrary location after the delete. ** But if that bit is set, then the cursor is left in a state such that ** the next call to BtreeNext() or BtreePrev() moves it to the same row ** as it would have been on if the call to BtreeDelete() had been omitted. ** ** The BTREE_AUXDELETE bit of flags indicates that is one of several deletes ** associated with a single table entry and its indexes. Only one of those ** deletes is considered the "primary" delete. The primary delete occurs ** on a cursor that is not a BTREE_FORDELETE cursor. All but one delete ** operation on non-FORDELETE cursors is tagged with the AUXDELETE flag. ** The BTREE_AUXDELETE bit is a hint that is not used by this implementation, ** but which might be used by alternative storage engines. */ int sqlite3BtreeDelete(BtCursor *pCur, u8 flags){ Btree *p = pCur->pBtree; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; int rc; /* Return code */ MemPage *pPage; /* Page to delete cell from */ unsigned char *pCell; /* Pointer to cell to delete */ int iCellIdx; /* Index of cell to delete */ int iCellDepth; /* Depth of node containing pCell */ CellInfo info; /* Size of the cell being deleted */ int bSkipnext = 0; /* Leaf cursor in SKIPNEXT state */ u8 bPreserve = flags & BTREE_SAVEPOSITION; /* Keep cursor valid */ assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCur) ); assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 ); assert( pCur->curFlags & BTCF_WriteFlag ); assert( hasSharedCacheTableLock(p, pCur->pgnoRoot, pCur->pKeyInfo!=0, 2) ); assert( !hasReadConflicts(p, pCur->pgnoRoot) ); assert( pCur->ixpPage->nCell ); assert( pCur->eState==CURSOR_VALID ); assert( (flags & ~(BTREE_SAVEPOSITION | BTREE_AUXDELETE))==0 ); iCellDepth = pCur->iPage; iCellIdx = pCur->ix; pPage = pCur->pPage; pCell = findCell(pPage, iCellIdx); /* If the bPreserve flag is set to true, then the cursor position must ** be preserved following this delete operation. If the current delete ** will cause a b-tree rebalance, then this is done by saving the cursor ** key and leaving the cursor in CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK state before ** returning. ** ** Or, if the current delete will not cause a rebalance, then the cursor ** will be left in CURSOR_SKIPNEXT state pointing to the entry immediately ** before or after the deleted entry. In this case set bSkipnext to true. */ if( bPreserve ){ if( !pPage->leaf || (pPage->nFree+cellSizePtr(pPage,pCell)+2)>(int)(pBt->usableSize*2/3) || pPage->nCell==1 /* See dbfuzz001.test for a test case */ ){ /* A b-tree rebalance will be required after deleting this entry. ** Save the cursor key. */ rc = saveCursorKey(pCur); if( rc ) return rc; }else{ bSkipnext = 1; } } /* If the page containing the entry to delete is not a leaf page, move ** the cursor to the largest entry in the tree that is smaller than ** the entry being deleted. This cell will replace the cell being deleted ** from the internal node. The 'previous' entry is used for this instead ** of the 'next' entry, as the previous entry is always a part of the ** sub-tree headed by the child page of the cell being deleted. This makes ** balancing the tree following the delete operation easier. */ if( !pPage->leaf ){ rc = sqlite3BtreePrevious(pCur, 0); assert( rc!=SQLITE_DONE ); if( rc ) return rc; } /* Save the positions of any other cursors open on this table before ** making any modifications. */ if( pCur->curFlags & BTCF_Multiple ){ rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, pCur->pgnoRoot, pCur); if( rc ) return rc; } /* If this is a delete operation to remove a row from a table b-tree, ** invalidate any incrblob cursors open on the row being deleted. */ if( pCur->pKeyInfo==0 ){ invalidateIncrblobCursors(p, pCur->pgnoRoot, pCur->info.nKey, 0); } /* Make the page containing the entry to be deleted writable. Then free any ** overflow pages associated with the entry and finally remove the cell ** itself from within the page. */ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage); if( rc ) return rc; rc = clearCell(pPage, pCell, &info); dropCell(pPage, iCellIdx, info.nSize, &rc); if( rc ) return rc; /* If the cell deleted was not located on a leaf page, then the cursor ** is currently pointing to the largest entry in the sub-tree headed ** by the child-page of the cell that was just deleted from an internal ** node. The cell from the leaf node needs to be moved to the internal ** node to replace the deleted cell. */ if( !pPage->leaf ){ MemPage *pLeaf = pCur->pPage; int nCell; Pgno n; unsigned char *pTmp; if( iCellDepthiPage-1 ){ n = pCur->apPage[iCellDepth+1]->pgno; }else{ n = pCur->pPage->pgno; } pCell = findCell(pLeaf, pLeaf->nCell-1); if( pCell<&pLeaf->aData[4] ) return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; nCell = pLeaf->xCellSize(pLeaf, pCell); assert( MX_CELL_SIZE(pBt) >= nCell ); pTmp = pBt->pTmpSpace; assert( pTmp!=0 ); rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pLeaf->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ insertCell(pPage, iCellIdx, pCell-4, nCell+4, pTmp, n, &rc); } dropCell(pLeaf, pLeaf->nCell-1, nCell, &rc); if( rc ) return rc; } /* Balance the tree. If the entry deleted was located on a leaf page, ** then the cursor still points to that page. In this case the first ** call to balance() repairs the tree, and the if(...) condition is ** never true. ** ** Otherwise, if the entry deleted was on an internal node page, then ** pCur is pointing to the leaf page from which a cell was removed to ** replace the cell deleted from the internal node. This is slightly ** tricky as the leaf node may be underfull, and the internal node may ** be either under or overfull. In this case run the balancing algorithm ** on the leaf node first. If the balance proceeds far enough up the ** tree that we can be sure that any problem in the internal node has ** been corrected, so be it. Otherwise, after balancing the leaf node, ** walk the cursor up the tree to the internal node and balance it as ** well. */ rc = balance(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pCur->iPage>iCellDepth ){ releasePageNotNull(pCur->pPage); pCur->iPage--; while( pCur->iPage>iCellDepth ){ releasePage(pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage--]); } pCur->pPage = pCur->apPage[pCur->iPage]; rc = balance(pCur); } if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ if( bSkipnext ){ assert( bPreserve && (pCur->iPage==iCellDepth || CORRUPT_DB) ); assert( pPage==pCur->pPage || CORRUPT_DB ); assert( (pPage->nCell>0 || CORRUPT_DB) && iCellIdx<=pPage->nCell ); pCur->eState = CURSOR_SKIPNEXT; if( iCellIdx>=pPage->nCell ){ pCur->skipNext = -1; pCur->ix = pPage->nCell-1; }else{ pCur->skipNext = 1; } }else{ rc = moveToRoot(pCur); if( bPreserve ){ btreeReleaseAllCursorPages(pCur); pCur->eState = CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK; } if( rc==SQLITE_EMPTY ) rc = SQLITE_OK; } } return rc; } /* ** Create a new BTree table. Write into *piTable the page ** number for the root page of the new table. ** ** The type of type is determined by the flags parameter. Only the ** following values of flags are currently in use. Other values for ** flags might not work: ** ** BTREE_INTKEY|BTREE_LEAFDATA Used for SQL tables with rowid keys ** BTREE_ZERODATA Used for SQL indices */ static int btreeCreateTable(Btree *p, int *piTable, int createTabFlags){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; MemPage *pRoot; Pgno pgnoRoot; int rc; int ptfFlags; /* Page-type flage for the root page of new table */ assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( (pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 ); #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pRoot, &pgnoRoot, 1, 0); if( rc ){ return rc; } #else if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ Pgno pgnoMove; /* Move a page here to make room for the root-page */ MemPage *pPageMove; /* The page to move to. */ /* Creating a new table may probably require moving an existing database ** to make room for the new tables root page. In case this page turns ** out to be an overflow page, delete all overflow page-map caches ** held by open cursors. */ invalidateAllOverflowCache(pBt); /* Read the value of meta[3] from the database to determine where the ** root page of the new table should go. meta[3] is the largest root-page ** created so far, so the new root-page is (meta[3]+1). */ sqlite3BtreeGetMeta(p, BTREE_LARGEST_ROOT_PAGE, &pgnoRoot); pgnoRoot++; /* The new root-page may not be allocated on a pointer-map page, or the ** PENDING_BYTE page. */ while( pgnoRoot==PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, pgnoRoot) || pgnoRoot==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ){ pgnoRoot++; } assert( pgnoRoot>=3 || CORRUPT_DB ); testcase( pgnoRoot<3 ); /* Allocate a page. The page that currently resides at pgnoRoot will ** be moved to the allocated page (unless the allocated page happens ** to reside at pgnoRoot). */ rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pPageMove, &pgnoMove, pgnoRoot, BTALLOC_EXACT); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } if( pgnoMove!=pgnoRoot ){ /* pgnoRoot is the page that will be used for the root-page of ** the new table (assuming an error did not occur). But we were ** allocated pgnoMove. If required (i.e. if it was not allocated ** by extending the file), the current page at position pgnoMove ** is already journaled. */ u8 eType = 0; Pgno iPtrPage = 0; /* Save the positions of any open cursors. This is required in ** case they are holding a reference to an xFetch reference ** corresponding to page pgnoRoot. */ rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, 0, 0); releasePage(pPageMove); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } /* Move the page currently at pgnoRoot to pgnoMove. */ rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, pgnoRoot, &pRoot, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } rc = ptrmapGet(pBt, pgnoRoot, &eType, &iPtrPage); if( eType==PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE || eType==PTRMAP_FREEPAGE ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(pRoot); return rc; } assert( eType!=PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE ); assert( eType!=PTRMAP_FREEPAGE ); rc = relocatePage(pBt, pRoot, eType, iPtrPage, pgnoMove, 0); releasePage(pRoot); /* Obtain the page at pgnoRoot */ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, pgnoRoot, &pRoot, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pRoot->pDbPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ releasePage(pRoot); return rc; } }else{ pRoot = pPageMove; } /* Update the pointer-map and meta-data with the new root-page number. */ ptrmapPut(pBt, pgnoRoot, PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE, 0, &rc); if( rc ){ releasePage(pRoot); return rc; } /* When the new root page was allocated, page 1 was made writable in ** order either to increase the database filesize, or to decrement the ** freelist count. Hence, the sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta() call cannot fail. */ assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage) ); rc = sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta(p, 4, pgnoRoot); if( NEVER(rc) ){ releasePage(pRoot); return rc; } }else{ rc = allocateBtreePage(pBt, &pRoot, &pgnoRoot, 1, 0); if( rc ) return rc; } #endif assert( sqlite3PagerIswriteable(pRoot->pDbPage) ); if( createTabFlags & BTREE_INTKEY ){ ptfFlags = PTF_INTKEY | PTF_LEAFDATA | PTF_LEAF; }else{ ptfFlags = PTF_ZERODATA | PTF_LEAF; } zeroPage(pRoot, ptfFlags); sqlite3PagerUnref(pRoot->pDbPage); assert( (pBt->openFlags & BTREE_SINGLE)==0 || pgnoRoot==2 ); *piTable = (int)pgnoRoot; return SQLITE_OK; } int sqlite3BtreeCreateTable(Btree *p, int *piTable, int flags){ int rc; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = btreeCreateTable(p, piTable, flags); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** Erase the given database page and all its children. Return ** the page to the freelist. */ static int clearDatabasePage( BtShared *pBt, /* The BTree that contains the table */ Pgno pgno, /* Page number to clear */ int freePageFlag, /* Deallocate page if true */ int *pnChange /* Add number of Cells freed to this counter */ ){ MemPage *pPage; int rc; unsigned char *pCell; int i; int hdr; CellInfo info; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pBt->mutex) ); if( pgno>btreePagecount(pBt) ){ return SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; } rc = getAndInitPage(pBt, pgno, &pPage, 0, 0); if( rc ) return rc; if( pPage->bBusy ){ rc = SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT; goto cleardatabasepage_out; } pPage->bBusy = 1; hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; for(i=0; inCell; i++){ pCell = findCell(pPage, i); if( !pPage->leaf ){ rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, get4byte(pCell), 1, pnChange); if( rc ) goto cleardatabasepage_out; } rc = clearCell(pPage, pCell, &info); if( rc ) goto cleardatabasepage_out; } if( !pPage->leaf ){ rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, get4byte(&pPage->aData[hdr+8]), 1, pnChange); if( rc ) goto cleardatabasepage_out; }else if( pnChange ){ assert( pPage->intKey || CORRUPT_DB ); testcase( !pPage->intKey ); *pnChange += pPage->nCell; } if( freePageFlag ){ freePage(pPage, &rc); }else if( (rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pPage->pDbPage))==0 ){ zeroPage(pPage, pPage->aData[hdr] | PTF_LEAF); } cleardatabasepage_out: pPage->bBusy = 0; releasePage(pPage); return rc; } /* ** Delete all information from a single table in the database. iTable is ** the page number of the root of the table. After this routine returns, ** the root page is empty, but still exists. ** ** This routine will fail with SQLITE_LOCKED if there are any open ** read cursors on the table. Open write cursors are moved to the ** root of the table. ** ** If pnChange is not NULL, then table iTable must be an intkey table. The ** integer value pointed to by pnChange is incremented by the number of ** entries in the table. */ int sqlite3BtreeClearTable(Btree *p, int iTable, int *pnChange){ int rc; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); rc = saveAllCursors(pBt, (Pgno)iTable, 0); if( SQLITE_OK==rc ){ /* Invalidate all incrblob cursors open on table iTable (assuming iTable ** is the root of a table b-tree - if it is not, the following call is ** a no-op). */ invalidateIncrblobCursors(p, (Pgno)iTable, 0, 1); rc = clearDatabasePage(pBt, (Pgno)iTable, 0, pnChange); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** Delete all information from the single table that pCur is open on. ** ** This routine only work for pCur on an ephemeral table. */ int sqlite3BtreeClearTableOfCursor(BtCursor *pCur){ return sqlite3BtreeClearTable(pCur->pBtree, pCur->pgnoRoot, 0); } /* ** Erase all information in a table and add the root of the table to ** the freelist. Except, the root of the principle table (the one on ** page 1) is never added to the freelist. ** ** This routine will fail with SQLITE_LOCKED if there are any open ** cursors on the table. ** ** If AUTOVACUUM is enabled and the page at iTable is not the last ** root page in the database file, then the last root page ** in the database file is moved into the slot formerly occupied by ** iTable and that last slot formerly occupied by the last root page ** is added to the freelist instead of iTable. In this say, all ** root pages are kept at the beginning of the database file, which ** is necessary for AUTOVACUUM to work right. *piMoved is set to the ** page number that used to be the last root page in the file before ** the move. If no page gets moved, *piMoved is set to 0. ** The last root page is recorded in meta[3] and the value of ** meta[3] is updated by this procedure. */ static int btreeDropTable(Btree *p, Pgno iTable, int *piMoved){ int rc; MemPage *pPage = 0; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; assert( sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(p) ); assert( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( iTable>=2 ); rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, (Pgno)iTable, &pPage, 0); if( rc ) return rc; rc = sqlite3BtreeClearTable(p, iTable, 0); if( rc ){ releasePage(pPage); return rc; } *piMoved = 0; #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM freePage(pPage, &rc); releasePage(pPage); #else if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ Pgno maxRootPgno; sqlite3BtreeGetMeta(p, BTREE_LARGEST_ROOT_PAGE, &maxRootPgno); if( iTable==maxRootPgno ){ /* If the table being dropped is the table with the largest root-page ** number in the database, put the root page on the free list. */ freePage(pPage, &rc); releasePage(pPage); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } }else{ /* The table being dropped does not have the largest root-page ** number in the database. So move the page that does into the ** gap left by the deleted root-page. */ MemPage *pMove; releasePage(pPage); rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, maxRootPgno, &pMove, 0); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } rc = relocatePage(pBt, pMove, PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE, 0, iTable, 0); releasePage(pMove); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } pMove = 0; rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, maxRootPgno, &pMove, 0); freePage(pMove, &rc); releasePage(pMove); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } *piMoved = maxRootPgno; } /* Set the new 'max-root-page' value in the database header. This ** is the old value less one, less one more if that happens to ** be a root-page number, less one again if that is the ** PENDING_BYTE_PAGE. */ maxRootPgno--; while( maxRootPgno==PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) || PTRMAP_ISPAGE(pBt, maxRootPgno) ){ maxRootPgno--; } assert( maxRootPgno!=PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt) ); rc = sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta(p, 4, maxRootPgno); }else{ freePage(pPage, &rc); releasePage(pPage); } #endif return rc; } int sqlite3BtreeDropTable(Btree *p, int iTable, int *piMoved){ int rc; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = btreeDropTable(p, iTable, piMoved); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } /* ** This function may only be called if the b-tree connection already ** has a read or write transaction open on the database. ** ** Read the meta-information out of a database file. Meta[0] ** is the number of free pages currently in the database. Meta[1] ** through meta[15] are available for use by higher layers. Meta[0] ** is read-only, the others are read/write. ** ** The schema layer numbers meta values differently. At the schema ** layer (and the SetCookie and ReadCookie opcodes) the number of ** free pages is not visible. So Cookie[0] is the same as Meta[1]. ** ** This routine treats Meta[BTREE_DATA_VERSION] as a special case. Instead ** of reading the value out of the header, it instead loads the "DataVersion" ** from the pager. The BTREE_DATA_VERSION value is not actually stored in the ** database file. It is a number computed by the pager. But its access ** pattern is the same as header meta values, and so it is convenient to ** read it from this routine. */ void sqlite3BtreeGetMeta(Btree *p, int idx, u32 *pMeta){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( p->inTrans>TRANS_NONE ); assert( SQLITE_OK==querySharedCacheTableLock(p, MASTER_ROOT, READ_LOCK) ); assert( pBt->pPage1 ); assert( idx>=0 && idx<=15 ); if( idx==BTREE_DATA_VERSION ){ *pMeta = sqlite3PagerDataVersion(pBt->pPager) + p->iDataVersion; }else{ *pMeta = get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36 + idx*4]); } /* If auto-vacuum is disabled in this build and this is an auto-vacuum ** database, mark the database as read-only. */ #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( idx==BTREE_LARGEST_ROOT_PAGE && *pMeta>0 ){ pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_READ_ONLY; } #endif sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } /* ** Write meta-information back into the database. Meta[0] is ** read-only and may not be written. */ int sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta(Btree *p, int idx, u32 iMeta){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; unsigned char *pP1; int rc; assert( idx>=1 && idx<=15 ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( pBt->pPage1!=0 ); pP1 = pBt->pPage1->aData; rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ put4byte(&pP1[36 + idx*4], iMeta); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( idx==BTREE_INCR_VACUUM ){ assert( pBt->autoVacuum || iMeta==0 ); assert( iMeta==0 || iMeta==1 ); pBt->incrVacuum = (u8)iMeta; } #endif } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_BTREECOUNT /* ** The first argument, pCur, is a cursor opened on some b-tree. Count the ** number of entries in the b-tree and write the result to *pnEntry. ** ** SQLITE_OK is returned if the operation is successfully executed. ** Otherwise, if an error is encountered (i.e. an IO error or database ** corruption) an SQLite error code is returned. */ int sqlite3BtreeCount(BtCursor *pCur, i64 *pnEntry){ i64 nEntry = 0; /* Value to return in *pnEntry */ int rc; /* Return code */ rc = moveToRoot(pCur); if( rc==SQLITE_EMPTY ){ *pnEntry = 0; return SQLITE_OK; } /* Unless an error occurs, the following loop runs one iteration for each ** page in the B-Tree structure (not including overflow pages). */ while( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ int iIdx; /* Index of child node in parent */ MemPage *pPage; /* Current page of the b-tree */ /* If this is a leaf page or the tree is not an int-key tree, then ** this page contains countable entries. Increment the entry counter ** accordingly. */ pPage = pCur->pPage; if( pPage->leaf || !pPage->intKey ){ nEntry += pPage->nCell; } /* pPage is a leaf node. This loop navigates the cursor so that it ** points to the first interior cell that it points to the parent of ** the next page in the tree that has not yet been visited. The ** pCur->aiIdx[pCur->iPage] value is set to the index of the parent cell ** of the page, or to the number of cells in the page if the next page ** to visit is the right-child of its parent. ** ** If all pages in the tree have been visited, return SQLITE_OK to the ** caller. */ if( pPage->leaf ){ do { if( pCur->iPage==0 ){ /* All pages of the b-tree have been visited. Return successfully. */ *pnEntry = nEntry; return moveToRoot(pCur); } moveToParent(pCur); }while ( pCur->ix>=pCur->pPage->nCell ); pCur->ix++; pPage = pCur->pPage; } /* Descend to the child node of the cell that the cursor currently ** points at. This is the right-child if (iIdx==pPage->nCell). */ iIdx = pCur->ix; if( iIdx==pPage->nCell ){ rc = moveToChild(pCur, get4byte(&pPage->aData[pPage->hdrOffset+8])); }else{ rc = moveToChild(pCur, get4byte(findCell(pPage, iIdx))); } } /* An error has occurred. Return an error code. */ return rc; } #endif /* ** Return the pager associated with a BTree. This routine is used for ** testing and debugging only. */ Pager *sqlite3BtreePager(Btree *p){ return p->pBt->pPager; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK /* ** Append a message to the error message string. */ static void checkAppendMsg( IntegrityCk *pCheck, const char *zFormat, ... ){ va_list ap; if( !pCheck->mxErr ) return; pCheck->mxErr--; pCheck->nErr++; va_start(ap, zFormat); if( pCheck->errMsg.nChar ){ sqlite3_str_append(&pCheck->errMsg, "\n", 1); } if( pCheck->zPfx ){ sqlite3_str_appendf(&pCheck->errMsg, pCheck->zPfx, pCheck->v1, pCheck->v2); } sqlite3_str_vappendf(&pCheck->errMsg, zFormat, ap); va_end(ap); if( pCheck->errMsg.accError==SQLITE_NOMEM ){ pCheck->mallocFailed = 1; } } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK /* ** Return non-zero if the bit in the IntegrityCk.aPgRef[] array that ** corresponds to page iPg is already set. */ static int getPageReferenced(IntegrityCk *pCheck, Pgno iPg){ assert( iPg<=pCheck->nPage && sizeof(pCheck->aPgRef[0])==1 ); return (pCheck->aPgRef[iPg/8] & (1 << (iPg & 0x07))); } /* ** Set the bit in the IntegrityCk.aPgRef[] array that corresponds to page iPg. */ static void setPageReferenced(IntegrityCk *pCheck, Pgno iPg){ assert( iPg<=pCheck->nPage && sizeof(pCheck->aPgRef[0])==1 ); pCheck->aPgRef[iPg/8] |= (1 << (iPg & 0x07)); } /* ** Add 1 to the reference count for page iPage. If this is the second ** reference to the page, add an error message to pCheck->zErrMsg. ** Return 1 if there are 2 or more references to the page and 0 if ** if this is the first reference to the page. ** ** Also check that the page number is in bounds. */ static int checkRef(IntegrityCk *pCheck, Pgno iPage){ if( iPage>pCheck->nPage || iPage==0 ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "invalid page number %d", iPage); return 1; } if( getPageReferenced(pCheck, iPage) ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "2nd reference to page %d", iPage); return 1; } setPageReferenced(pCheck, iPage); return 0; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM /* ** Check that the entry in the pointer-map for page iChild maps to ** page iParent, pointer type ptrType. If not, append an error message ** to pCheck. */ static void checkPtrmap( IntegrityCk *pCheck, /* Integrity check context */ Pgno iChild, /* Child page number */ u8 eType, /* Expected pointer map type */ Pgno iParent /* Expected pointer map parent page number */ ){ int rc; u8 ePtrmapType; Pgno iPtrmapParent; rc = ptrmapGet(pCheck->pBt, iChild, &ePtrmapType, &iPtrmapParent); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ if( rc==SQLITE_NOMEM || rc==SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM ) pCheck->mallocFailed = 1; checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Failed to read ptrmap key=%d", iChild); return; } if( ePtrmapType!=eType || iPtrmapParent!=iParent ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Bad ptr map entry key=%d expected=(%d,%d) got=(%d,%d)", iChild, eType, iParent, ePtrmapType, iPtrmapParent); } } #endif /* ** Check the integrity of the freelist or of an overflow page list. ** Verify that the number of pages on the list is N. */ static void checkList( IntegrityCk *pCheck, /* Integrity checking context */ int isFreeList, /* True for a freelist. False for overflow page list */ int iPage, /* Page number for first page in the list */ int N /* Expected number of pages in the list */ ){ int i; int expected = N; int nErrAtStart = pCheck->nErr; while( iPage!=0 && pCheck->mxErr ){ DbPage *pOvflPage; unsigned char *pOvflData; if( checkRef(pCheck, iPage) ) break; N--; if( sqlite3PagerGet(pCheck->pPager, (Pgno)iPage, &pOvflPage, 0) ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "failed to get page %d", iPage); break; } pOvflData = (unsigned char *)sqlite3PagerGetData(pOvflPage); if( isFreeList ){ u32 n = (u32)get4byte(&pOvflData[4]); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pCheck->pBt->autoVacuum ){ checkPtrmap(pCheck, iPage, PTRMAP_FREEPAGE, 0); } #endif if( n>pCheck->pBt->usableSize/4-2 ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "freelist leaf count too big on page %d", iPage); N--; }else{ for(i=0; i<(int)n; i++){ Pgno iFreePage = get4byte(&pOvflData[8+i*4]); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pCheck->pBt->autoVacuum ){ checkPtrmap(pCheck, iFreePage, PTRMAP_FREEPAGE, 0); } #endif checkRef(pCheck, iFreePage); } N -= n; } } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM else{ /* If this database supports auto-vacuum and iPage is not the last ** page in this overflow list, check that the pointer-map entry for ** the following page matches iPage. */ if( pCheck->pBt->autoVacuum && N>0 ){ i = get4byte(pOvflData); checkPtrmap(pCheck, i, PTRMAP_OVERFLOW2, iPage); } } #endif iPage = get4byte(pOvflData); sqlite3PagerUnref(pOvflPage); } if( N && nErrAtStart==pCheck->nErr ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "%s is %d but should be %d", isFreeList ? "size" : "overflow list length", expected-N, expected); } } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK */ /* ** An implementation of a min-heap. ** ** aHeap[0] is the number of elements on the heap. aHeap[1] is the ** root element. The daughter nodes of aHeap[N] are aHeap[N*2] ** and aHeap[N*2+1]. ** ** The heap property is this: Every node is less than or equal to both ** of its daughter nodes. A consequence of the heap property is that the ** root node aHeap[1] is always the minimum value currently in the heap. ** ** The btreeHeapInsert() routine inserts an unsigned 32-bit number onto ** the heap, preserving the heap property. The btreeHeapPull() routine ** removes the root element from the heap (the minimum value in the heap) ** and then moves other nodes around as necessary to preserve the heap ** property. ** ** This heap is used for cell overlap and coverage testing. Each u32 ** entry represents the span of a cell or freeblock on a btree page. ** The upper 16 bits are the index of the first byte of a range and the ** lower 16 bits are the index of the last byte of that range. */ static void btreeHeapInsert(u32 *aHeap, u32 x){ u32 j, i = ++aHeap[0]; aHeap[i] = x; while( (j = i/2)>0 && aHeap[j]>aHeap[i] ){ x = aHeap[j]; aHeap[j] = aHeap[i]; aHeap[i] = x; i = j; } } static int btreeHeapPull(u32 *aHeap, u32 *pOut){ u32 j, i, x; if( (x = aHeap[0])==0 ) return 0; *pOut = aHeap[1]; aHeap[1] = aHeap[x]; aHeap[x] = 0xffffffff; aHeap[0]--; i = 1; while( (j = i*2)<=aHeap[0] ){ if( aHeap[j]>aHeap[j+1] ) j++; if( aHeap[i]zPfx; int saved_v1 = pCheck->v1; int saved_v2 = pCheck->v2; u8 savedIsInit = 0; /* Check that the page exists */ pBt = pCheck->pBt; usableSize = pBt->usableSize; if( iPage==0 ) return 0; if( checkRef(pCheck, iPage) ) return 0; pCheck->zPfx = "Page %d: "; pCheck->v1 = iPage; if( (rc = btreeGetPage(pBt, (Pgno)iPage, &pPage, 0))!=0 ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "unable to get the page. error code=%d", rc); goto end_of_check; } /* Clear MemPage.isInit to make sure the corruption detection code in ** btreeInitPage() is executed. */ savedIsInit = pPage->isInit; pPage->isInit = 0; if( (rc = btreeInitPage(pPage))!=0 ){ assert( rc==SQLITE_CORRUPT ); /* The only possible error from InitPage */ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "btreeInitPage() returns error code %d", rc); goto end_of_check; } data = pPage->aData; hdr = pPage->hdrOffset; /* Set up for cell analysis */ pCheck->zPfx = "On tree page %d cell %d: "; contentOffset = get2byteNotZero(&data[hdr+5]); assert( contentOffset<=usableSize ); /* Enforced by btreeInitPage() */ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-37002-32774 The two-byte integer at offset 3 gives the ** number of cells on the page. */ nCell = get2byte(&data[hdr+3]); assert( pPage->nCell==nCell ); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-23882-45353 The cell pointer array of a b-tree page ** immediately follows the b-tree page header. */ cellStart = hdr + 12 - 4*pPage->leaf; assert( pPage->aCellIdx==&data[cellStart] ); pCellIdx = &data[cellStart + 2*(nCell-1)]; if( !pPage->leaf ){ /* Analyze the right-child page of internal pages */ pgno = get4byte(&data[hdr+8]); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ pCheck->zPfx = "On page %d at right child: "; checkPtrmap(pCheck, pgno, PTRMAP_BTREE, iPage); } #endif depth = checkTreePage(pCheck, pgno, &maxKey, maxKey); keyCanBeEqual = 0; }else{ /* For leaf pages, the coverage check will occur in the same loop ** as the other cell checks, so initialize the heap. */ heap = pCheck->heap; heap[0] = 0; } /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-02776-14802 The cell pointer array consists of K 2-byte ** integer offsets to the cell contents. */ for(i=nCell-1; i>=0 && pCheck->mxErr; i--){ CellInfo info; /* Check cell size */ pCheck->v2 = i; assert( pCellIdx==&data[cellStart + i*2] ); pc = get2byteAligned(pCellIdx); pCellIdx -= 2; if( pcusableSize-4 ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Offset %d out of range %d..%d", pc, contentOffset, usableSize-4); doCoverageCheck = 0; continue; } pCell = &data[pc]; pPage->xParseCell(pPage, pCell, &info); if( pc+info.nSize>usableSize ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Extends off end of page"); doCoverageCheck = 0; continue; } /* Check for integer primary key out of range */ if( pPage->intKey ){ if( keyCanBeEqual ? (info.nKey > maxKey) : (info.nKey >= maxKey) ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Rowid %lld out of order", info.nKey); } maxKey = info.nKey; keyCanBeEqual = 0; /* Only the first key on the page may ==maxKey */ } /* Check the content overflow list */ if( info.nPayload>info.nLocal ){ int nPage; /* Number of pages on the overflow chain */ Pgno pgnoOvfl; /* First page of the overflow chain */ assert( pc + info.nSize - 4 <= usableSize ); nPage = (info.nPayload - info.nLocal + usableSize - 5)/(usableSize - 4); pgnoOvfl = get4byte(&pCell[info.nSize - 4]); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ checkPtrmap(pCheck, pgnoOvfl, PTRMAP_OVERFLOW1, iPage); } #endif checkList(pCheck, 0, pgnoOvfl, nPage); } if( !pPage->leaf ){ /* Check sanity of left child page for internal pages */ pgno = get4byte(pCell); #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ checkPtrmap(pCheck, pgno, PTRMAP_BTREE, iPage); } #endif d2 = checkTreePage(pCheck, pgno, &maxKey, maxKey); keyCanBeEqual = 0; if( d2!=depth ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Child page depth differs"); depth = d2; } }else{ /* Populate the coverage-checking heap for leaf pages */ btreeHeapInsert(heap, (pc<<16)|(pc+info.nSize-1)); } } *piMinKey = maxKey; /* Check for complete coverage of the page */ pCheck->zPfx = 0; if( doCoverageCheck && pCheck->mxErr>0 ){ /* For leaf pages, the min-heap has already been initialized and the ** cells have already been inserted. But for internal pages, that has ** not yet been done, so do it now */ if( !pPage->leaf ){ heap = pCheck->heap; heap[0] = 0; for(i=nCell-1; i>=0; i--){ u32 size; pc = get2byteAligned(&data[cellStart+i*2]); size = pPage->xCellSize(pPage, &data[pc]); btreeHeapInsert(heap, (pc<<16)|(pc+size-1)); } } /* Add the freeblocks to the min-heap ** ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-20690-50594 The second field of the b-tree page header ** is the offset of the first freeblock, or zero if there are no ** freeblocks on the page. */ i = get2byte(&data[hdr+1]); while( i>0 ){ int size, j; assert( (u32)i<=usableSize-4 ); /* Enforced by btreeInitPage() */ size = get2byte(&data[i+2]); assert( (u32)(i+size)<=usableSize ); /* Enforced by btreeInitPage() */ btreeHeapInsert(heap, (((u32)i)<<16)|(i+size-1)); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-58208-19414 The first 2 bytes of a freeblock are a ** big-endian integer which is the offset in the b-tree page of the next ** freeblock in the chain, or zero if the freeblock is the last on the ** chain. */ j = get2byte(&data[i]); /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-06866-39125 Freeblocks are always connected in order of ** increasing offset. */ assert( j==0 || j>i+size ); /* Enforced by btreeInitPage() */ assert( (u32)j<=usableSize-4 ); /* Enforced by btreeInitPage() */ i = j; } /* Analyze the min-heap looking for overlap between cells and/or ** freeblocks, and counting the number of untracked bytes in nFrag. ** ** Each min-heap entry is of the form: (start_address<<16)|end_address. ** There is an implied first entry the covers the page header, the cell ** pointer index, and the gap between the cell pointer index and the start ** of cell content. ** ** The loop below pulls entries from the min-heap in order and compares ** the start_address against the previous end_address. If there is an ** overlap, that means bytes are used multiple times. If there is a gap, ** that gap is added to the fragmentation count. */ nFrag = 0; prev = contentOffset - 1; /* Implied first min-heap entry */ while( btreeHeapPull(heap,&x) ){ if( (prev&0xffff)>=(x>>16) ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Multiple uses for byte %u of page %d", x>>16, iPage); break; }else{ nFrag += (x>>16) - (prev&0xffff) - 1; prev = x; } } nFrag += usableSize - (prev&0xffff) - 1; /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-43263-13491 The total number of bytes in all fragments ** is stored in the fifth field of the b-tree page header. ** EVIDENCE-OF: R-07161-27322 The one-byte integer at offset 7 gives the ** number of fragmented free bytes within the cell content area. */ if( heap[0]==0 && nFrag!=data[hdr+7] ){ checkAppendMsg(pCheck, "Fragmentation of %d bytes reported as %d on page %d", nFrag, data[hdr+7], iPage); } } end_of_check: if( !doCoverageCheck ) pPage->isInit = savedIsInit; releasePage(pPage); pCheck->zPfx = saved_zPfx; pCheck->v1 = saved_v1; pCheck->v2 = saved_v2; return depth+1; } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK /* ** This routine does a complete check of the given BTree file. aRoot[] is ** an array of pages numbers were each page number is the root page of ** a table. nRoot is the number of entries in aRoot. ** ** A read-only or read-write transaction must be opened before calling ** this function. ** ** Write the number of error seen in *pnErr. Except for some memory ** allocation errors, an error message held in memory obtained from ** malloc is returned if *pnErr is non-zero. If *pnErr==0 then NULL is ** returned. If a memory allocation error occurs, NULL is returned. */ char *sqlite3BtreeIntegrityCheck( Btree *p, /* The btree to be checked */ int *aRoot, /* An array of root pages numbers for individual trees */ int nRoot, /* Number of entries in aRoot[] */ int mxErr, /* Stop reporting errors after this many */ int *pnErr /* Write number of errors seen to this variable */ ){ Pgno i; IntegrityCk sCheck; BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; int savedDbFlags = pBt->db->flags; char zErr[100]; VVA_ONLY( int nRef ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); assert( p->inTrans>TRANS_NONE && pBt->inTransaction>TRANS_NONE ); VVA_ONLY( nRef = sqlite3PagerRefcount(pBt->pPager) ); assert( nRef>=0 ); sCheck.pBt = pBt; sCheck.pPager = pBt->pPager; sCheck.nPage = btreePagecount(sCheck.pBt); sCheck.mxErr = mxErr; sCheck.nErr = 0; sCheck.mallocFailed = 0; sCheck.zPfx = 0; sCheck.v1 = 0; sCheck.v2 = 0; sCheck.aPgRef = 0; sCheck.heap = 0; sqlite3StrAccumInit(&sCheck.errMsg, 0, zErr, sizeof(zErr), SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH); sCheck.errMsg.printfFlags = SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL; if( sCheck.nPage==0 ){ goto integrity_ck_cleanup; } sCheck.aPgRef = sqlite3MallocZero((sCheck.nPage / 8)+ 1); if( !sCheck.aPgRef ){ sCheck.mallocFailed = 1; goto integrity_ck_cleanup; } sCheck.heap = (u32*)sqlite3PageMalloc( pBt->pageSize ); if( sCheck.heap==0 ){ sCheck.mallocFailed = 1; goto integrity_ck_cleanup; } i = PENDING_BYTE_PAGE(pBt); if( i<=sCheck.nPage ) setPageReferenced(&sCheck, i); /* Check the integrity of the freelist */ sCheck.zPfx = "Main freelist: "; checkList(&sCheck, 1, get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[32]), get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[36])); sCheck.zPfx = 0; /* Check all the tables. */ #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( pBt->autoVacuum ){ int mx = 0; int mxInHdr; for(i=0; (int)ipPage1->aData[52]); if( mx!=mxInHdr ){ checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, "max rootpage (%d) disagrees with header (%d)", mx, mxInHdr ); } }else if( get4byte(&pBt->pPage1->aData[64])!=0 ){ checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, "incremental_vacuum enabled with a max rootpage of zero" ); } #endif testcase( pBt->db->flags & SQLITE_CellSizeCk ); pBt->db->flags &= ~(u64)SQLITE_CellSizeCk; for(i=0; (int)iautoVacuum && aRoot[i]>1 ){ checkPtrmap(&sCheck, aRoot[i], PTRMAP_ROOTPAGE, 0); } #endif checkTreePage(&sCheck, aRoot[i], ¬Used, LARGEST_INT64); } pBt->db->flags = savedDbFlags; /* Make sure every page in the file is referenced */ for(i=1; i<=sCheck.nPage && sCheck.mxErr; i++){ #ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM if( getPageReferenced(&sCheck, i)==0 ){ checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, "Page %d is never used", i); } #else /* If the database supports auto-vacuum, make sure no tables contain ** references to pointer-map pages. */ if( getPageReferenced(&sCheck, i)==0 && (PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, i)!=i || !pBt->autoVacuum) ){ checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, "Page %d is never used", i); } if( getPageReferenced(&sCheck, i)!=0 && (PTRMAP_PAGENO(pBt, i)==i && pBt->autoVacuum) ){ checkAppendMsg(&sCheck, "Pointer map page %d is referenced", i); } #endif } /* Clean up and report errors. */ integrity_ck_cleanup: sqlite3PageFree(sCheck.heap); sqlite3_free(sCheck.aPgRef); if( sCheck.mallocFailed ){ sqlite3_str_reset(&sCheck.errMsg); sCheck.nErr++; } *pnErr = sCheck.nErr; if( sCheck.nErr==0 ) sqlite3_str_reset(&sCheck.errMsg); /* Make sure this analysis did not leave any unref() pages. */ assert( nRef==sqlite3PagerRefcount(pBt->pPager) ); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&sCheck.errMsg); } #endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK */ /* ** Return the full pathname of the underlying database file. Return ** an empty string if the database is in-memory or a TEMP database. ** ** The pager filename is invariant as long as the pager is ** open so it is safe to access without the BtShared mutex. */ const char *sqlite3BtreeGetFilename(Btree *p){ assert( p->pBt->pPager!=0 ); return sqlite3PagerFilename(p->pBt->pPager, 1); } /* ** Return the pathname of the journal file for this database. The return ** value of this routine is the same regardless of whether the journal file ** has been created or not. ** ** The pager journal filename is invariant as long as the pager is ** open so it is safe to access without the BtShared mutex. */ const char *sqlite3BtreeGetJournalname(Btree *p){ assert( p->pBt->pPager!=0 ); return sqlite3PagerJournalname(p->pBt->pPager); } /* ** Return non-zero if a transaction is active. */ int sqlite3BtreeIsInTrans(Btree *p){ assert( p==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); return (p && (p->inTrans==TRANS_WRITE)); } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL /* ** Run a checkpoint on the Btree passed as the first argument. ** ** Return SQLITE_LOCKED if this or any other connection has an open ** transaction on the shared-cache the argument Btree is connected to. ** ** Parameter eMode is one of SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE, FULL or RESTART. */ int sqlite3BtreeCheckpoint(Btree *p, int eMode, int *pnLog, int *pnCkpt){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; if( p ){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); if( pBt->inTransaction!=TRANS_NONE ){ rc = SQLITE_LOCKED; }else{ rc = sqlite3PagerCheckpoint(pBt->pPager, p->db, eMode, pnLog, pnCkpt); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } return rc; } #endif /* ** Return non-zero if a read (or write) transaction is active. */ int sqlite3BtreeIsInReadTrans(Btree *p){ assert( p ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); return p->inTrans!=TRANS_NONE; } int sqlite3BtreeIsInBackup(Btree *p){ assert( p ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); return p->nBackup!=0; } /* ** This function returns a pointer to a blob of memory associated with ** a single shared-btree. The memory is used by client code for its own ** purposes (for example, to store a high-level schema associated with ** the shared-btree). The btree layer manages reference counting issues. ** ** The first time this is called on a shared-btree, nBytes bytes of memory ** are allocated, zeroed, and returned to the caller. For each subsequent ** call the nBytes parameter is ignored and a pointer to the same blob ** of memory returned. ** ** If the nBytes parameter is 0 and the blob of memory has not yet been ** allocated, a null pointer is returned. If the blob has already been ** allocated, it is returned as normal. ** ** Just before the shared-btree is closed, the function passed as the ** xFree argument when the memory allocation was made is invoked on the ** blob of allocated memory. The xFree function should not call sqlite3_free() ** on the memory, the btree layer does that. */ void *sqlite3BtreeSchema(Btree *p, int nBytes, void(*xFree)(void *)){ BtShared *pBt = p->pBt; sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); if( !pBt->pSchema && nBytes ){ pBt->pSchema = sqlite3DbMallocZero(0, nBytes); pBt->xFreeSchema = xFree; } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return pBt->pSchema; } /* ** Return SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE if another user of the same shared ** btree as the argument handle holds an exclusive lock on the ** sqlite_master table. Otherwise SQLITE_OK. */ int sqlite3BtreeSchemaLocked(Btree *p){ int rc; assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->db->mutex) ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = querySharedCacheTableLock(p, MASTER_ROOT, READ_LOCK); assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || rc==SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE ); sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); return rc; } #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE /* ** Obtain a lock on the table whose root page is iTab. The ** lock is a write lock if isWritelock is true or a read lock ** if it is false. */ int sqlite3BtreeLockTable(Btree *p, int iTab, u8 isWriteLock){ int rc = SQLITE_OK; assert( p->inTrans!=TRANS_NONE ); if( p->sharable ){ u8 lockType = READ_LOCK + isWriteLock; assert( READ_LOCK+1==WRITE_LOCK ); assert( isWriteLock==0 || isWriteLock==1 ); sqlite3BtreeEnter(p); rc = querySharedCacheTableLock(p, iTab, lockType); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = setSharedCacheTableLock(p, iTab, lockType); } sqlite3BtreeLeave(p); } return rc; } #endif #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB /* ** Argument pCsr must be a cursor opened for writing on an ** INTKEY table currently pointing at a valid table entry. ** This function modifies the data stored as part of that entry. ** ** Only the data content may only be modified, it is not possible to ** change the length of the data stored. If this function is called with ** parameters that attempt to write past the end of the existing data, ** no modifications are made and SQLITE_CORRUPT is returned. */ int sqlite3BtreePutData(BtCursor *pCsr, u32 offset, u32 amt, void *z){ int rc; assert( cursorOwnsBtShared(pCsr) ); assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCsr->pBtree->db->mutex) ); assert( pCsr->curFlags & BTCF_Incrblob ); rc = restoreCursorPosition(pCsr); if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){ return rc; } assert( pCsr->eState!=CURSOR_REQUIRESEEK ); if( pCsr->eState!=CURSOR_VALID ){ return SQLITE_ABORT; } /* Save the positions of all other cursors open on this table. This is ** required in case any of them are holding references to an xFetch ** version of the b-tree page modified by the accessPayload call below. ** ** Note that pCsr must be open on a INTKEY table and saveCursorPosition() ** and hence saveAllCursors() cannot fail on a BTREE_INTKEY table, hence ** saveAllCursors can only return SQLITE_OK. */ VVA_ONLY(rc =) saveAllCursors(pCsr->pBt, pCsr->pgnoRoot, pCsr); assert( rc==SQLITE_OK ); /* Check some assumptions: ** (a) the cursor is open for writing, ** (b) there is a read/write transaction open, ** (c) the connection holds a write-lock on the table (if required), ** (d) there are no conflicting read-locks, and ** (e) the cursor points at a valid row of an intKey table. */ if( (pCsr->curFlags & BTCF_WriteFlag)==0 ){ return SQLITE_READONLY; } assert( (pCsr->pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)==0 && pCsr->pBt->inTransaction==TRANS_WRITE ); assert( hasSharedCacheTableLock(pCsr->pBtree, pCsr->pgnoRoot, 0, 2) ); assert( !hasReadConflicts(pCsr->pBtree, pCsr->pgnoRoot) ); assert( pCsr->pPage->intKey ); return accessPayload(pCsr, offset, amt, (unsigned char *)z, 1); } /* ** Mark this cursor as an incremental blob cursor. */ void sqlite3BtreeIncrblobCursor(BtCursor *pCur){ pCur->curFlags |= BTCF_Incrblob; pCur->pBtree->hasIncrblobCur = 1; } #endif /* ** Set both the "read version" (single byte at byte offset 18) and ** "write version" (single byte at byte offset 19) fields in the database ** header to iVersion. */ int sqlite3BtreeSetVersion(Btree *pBtree, int iVersion){ BtShared *pBt = pBtree->pBt; int rc; /* Return code */ assert( iVersion==1 || iVersion==2 ); /* If setting the version fields to 1, do not automatically open the ** WAL connection, even if the version fields are currently set to 2. */ pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_NO_WAL; if( iVersion==1 ) pBt->btsFlags |= BTS_NO_WAL; rc = sqlite3BtreeBeginTrans(pBtree, 0, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ u8 *aData = pBt->pPage1->aData; if( aData[18]!=(u8)iVersion || aData[19]!=(u8)iVersion ){ rc = sqlite3BtreeBeginTrans(pBtree, 2, 0); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ rc = sqlite3PagerWrite(pBt->pPage1->pDbPage); if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){ aData[18] = (u8)iVersion; aData[19] = (u8)iVersion; } } } } pBt->btsFlags &= ~BTS_NO_WAL; return rc; } /* ** Return true if the cursor has a hint specified. This routine is ** only used from within assert() statements */ int sqlite3BtreeCursorHasHint(BtCursor *pCsr, unsigned int mask){ return (pCsr->hints & mask)!=0; } /* ** Return true if the given Btree is read-only. */ int sqlite3BtreeIsReadonly(Btree *p){ return (p->pBt->btsFlags & BTS_READ_ONLY)!=0; } /* ** Return the size of the header added to each page by this module. */ int sqlite3HeaderSizeBtree(void){ return ROUND8(sizeof(MemPage)); } #if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) /* ** Return true if the Btree passed as the only argument is sharable. */ int sqlite3BtreeSharable(Btree *p){ return p->sharable; } /* ** Return the number of connections to the BtShared object accessed by ** the Btree handle passed as the only argument. For private caches ** this is always 1. For shared caches it may be 1 or greater. */ int sqlite3BtreeConnectionCount(Btree *p){ testcase( p->sharable ); return p->pBt->nRef; } #endif